jtag: linuxgpiod: drop extra parenthesis
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
540 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
541 @end itemize
542
543 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
544
545 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
546 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
547 these on the market.
548
549 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
550 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
551 of USB-based ones.
552
553 @itemize @bullet
554
555 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
557
558 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
559 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
560 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
561
562 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
563 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
564
565 @item @b{Wiggler2}
566 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
567
568 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
569 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
570
571 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
572 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
573
574 @item @b{arm-jtag}
575 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
576
577 @item @b{chameleon}
578 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
579
580 @item @b{Triton}
581 @* Unknown.
582
583 @item @b{Lattice}
584 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
585 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
586
587 @item @b{flashlink}
588 @* From STMicroelectronics;
589 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
590
591 @end itemize
592
593 @section Other...
594 @itemize @bullet
595
596 @item @b{ep93xx}
597 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
598
599 @item @b{at91rm9200}
600 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
601
602 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
603 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
604
605 @item @b{imx_gpio}
606 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
607
608 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
609 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
610 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
611
612 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
613 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
614
615 @end itemize
616
617 @node About Jim-Tcl
618 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
619 @cindex Jim-Tcl
620 @cindex tcl
621
622 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
623 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
624 command interpreter.
625
626 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
627 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
628 much of anything about Tcl.
629 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
630
631 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
632 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
633 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
634 OpenOCD mailing list.
635
636 @itemize @bullet
637 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
638 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
639 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
640 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
641 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
642 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
643
644 @item @b{Missing Features}
645 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
646 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
647 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
648 enabled in OpenOCD.
649
650 @item @b{Scripts}
651 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
652 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
653 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
654
655 @item @b{Commands}
656 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
657 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
658 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
659 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
660
661 @item @b{Historical Note}
662 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
663 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
664 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
665 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
666
667 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
668 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
669 @end itemize
670
671 @node Running
672 @chapter Running
673 @cindex command line options
674 @cindex logfile
675 @cindex directory search
676
677 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
678 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
679 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
680 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
681 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
682 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
683 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
684
685 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
686 tell it how each debug session should work.
687 The @option{--help} option shows:
688 @verbatim
689 bash$ openocd --help
690
691 --help | -h display this help
692 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
693 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
694 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
695 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
696 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
697 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
698 --command | -c run <command>
699 @end verbatim
700
701 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
702 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
703 To specify one or more different
704 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
705
706 @example
707 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
708 @end example
709
710 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
711 @enumerate
712 @item the current directory,
713 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
714 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
715 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
716 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
717 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
718 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
719 @end enumerate
720 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
721
722 @quotation Note
723 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
724 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
725 @end quotation
726
727 @section Simple setup, no customization
728
729 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
730 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
731 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
732 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
733 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
734
735 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
736 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
737 the server with some variation of one of the following:
738
739 @example
740 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
741 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
742 @end example
743
744 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
745 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
746 If all goes well you'll see output something like
747
748 @example
749 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
750 For bug reports, read
751 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
752 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
753 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
754 @end example
755
756 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
757 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
758 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
759
760 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
761
762 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
763 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
764 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
765 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
766 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
767 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
768 ensure that this always succeeds.
769 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
770 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
771 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
772 and then shut down without acting as a server.
773
774 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
775 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
776 those channels.
777
778 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
779 the @option{-d} option.
780
781 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
782 @option{-c} command line switch.
783
784 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
785 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
786 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
787 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
788 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
789 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
790 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
791
792 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
793 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
794
795 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
796 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
797 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
798 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
799
800 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
801 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
802
803 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
804 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
805 and start the OpenOCD server.
806 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
807 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
808 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
809 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
810
811 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
812
813 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
814 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
815 and a USB cable on the other.
816 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
817 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
818
819 @enumerate
820 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
821 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
822 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
823 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
824 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
825 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
826 debugging host.
827
828 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
829 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
830 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
831 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
832 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
833
834 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
835 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
836 with 1.2 Volt boards.
837
838 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
839 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
840 ways to connect the cable.
841 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
842 Be sure it's firmly connected.
843
844 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
845 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
846 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
847 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
848 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
849 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
850 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
851 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
852
853 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
854 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
855 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
856 but are tedious to set up.
857 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
858 adapter signals to the right board pins.
859
860 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
861 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
862 you are using to run OpenOCD.
863 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
864
865 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
866 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
867 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
868 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
869
870 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
871 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
872 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
873
874 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
875 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
876 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
877 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
878
879 @end enumerate
880
881 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
882 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
883 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
884
885 @section Project Directory
886
887 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
888
889 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
890 single directory for your work with a given board.
891 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
892 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
893 files accessed through semihosting,
894 and for code you upload to the target board.
895 It is also the natural place to write files,
896 such as log files and data you download from the board.
897
898 @section Configuration Basics
899
900 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
901 a variety of ways you can mix them.
902 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
903
904 @itemize
905 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
906 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
907 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
908 @end itemize
909
910 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
911 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
912 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
913
914 @example
915 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
916
917 # GDB can also flash my flash!
918 gdb_memory_map enable
919 gdb_flash_program enable
920
921 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
922 @end example
923
924 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
925
926 @example
927 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
928 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
929 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
930 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
931 @end example
932
933 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
934 each supporting a different development task.
935 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
936 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
937
938 @quotation Important
939 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
940 problems with how it treats variables.
941 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
942 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
943 that can be tested in a later script.
944 @end quotation
945
946 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
947 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
948 to simplify your work.
949
950 @section User Config Files
951 @cindex config file, user
952 @cindex user config file
953 @cindex config file, overview
954
955 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
956 in one place.
957 One of the following will match your situation best:
958
959 @itemize
960 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
961 provided by someone else.
962 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
963 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
964 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
965 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
966 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
967 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
968
969 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
970 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
971
972 @enumerate
973 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
974 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
975 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
976 @end enumerate
977
978 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
979 The first is an interface config file.
980 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
981 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
982 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
983 meet your deadline:
984
985 @example
986 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
987 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
988 @end example
989
990 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
991 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
992 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
993 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
994
995 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
996 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
997 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
998 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
999 target and board
1000 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1001 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1002
1003 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1004 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1005 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1006 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1007
1008 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1009 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1010 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1011 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1012 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1013
1014 @quotation Note
1015 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1016 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1017 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1018 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1019 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1020 @end quotation
1021
1022 @item
1023 You may may need to write some C code.
1024 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1025 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1026 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1027 a new chip architecture.
1028 @end itemize
1029
1030 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1031 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1032 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1033
1034 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1035 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1036 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1037 @itemize
1038
1039 @item
1040 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1041 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1042 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1043 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1044
1045 @item
1046 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1047 @cindex vector_catch
1048 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1049 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1050 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1051 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1052 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1053 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1054
1055 @item
1056 You might need to override some defaults.
1057 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1058 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1059
1060 @item
1061 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1062 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1063 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1064 @end itemize
1065
1066 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1067
1068 A few project-specific utility
1069 routines may well speed up your work.
1070 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1071
1072 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1073 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1074 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1075 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1076 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1077 may help:
1078
1079 @example
1080 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1081 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1082 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1083 # Leave the CPU halted.
1084 reset init
1085
1086 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1087 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1088
1089 # Start running.
1090 resume 0x20000000
1091 @}
1092 @end example
1093
1094 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1095 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1096 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1097 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1098 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1099
1100 @example
1101 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1102 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1103 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1104 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1105 reset init
1106
1107 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1108 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1109 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1110 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1111 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1112 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1113 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1114
1115 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1116 reset run
1117 @}
1118 @end example
1119
1120 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1121 from NAND.
1122 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1123 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1124 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1125
1126 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1127 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1128
1129 @section Target Software Changes
1130
1131 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1132 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1133 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1134 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1135 handling issues like:
1136
1137 @itemize @bullet
1138
1139 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1140 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1141 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1142 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1143 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1144 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1145 your debug sessions.
1146
1147 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1148 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1149 That might however be your only option.
1150
1151 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1152 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1153 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1154 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1155 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1156 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1157 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1158 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1159 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1160 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1161 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1162 instead of the whole thing.
1163 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1164 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1167 @cindex ARM semihosting
1168 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1169 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1170 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1171 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1172 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1173 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1174 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1175 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1176 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1177 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1178 NAND or SPI flash.
1179
1180 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1181 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1182 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1183 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1184 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1185
1186 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1187 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1188 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1189 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1190 registers which can be used to change various features including
1191 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1192 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1193 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1194 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1195 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1196
1197 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1198 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1199 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1200 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1201 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1202
1203 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1204 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1205 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1206 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1207 early code execution can be debugged
1208 or firmware can be replaced.
1209
1210 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1211 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1212 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1213 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1214 operations like writing to memory.)
1215
1216 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1217 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1218 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1219 various kinds of message.
1220 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1221
1222 @end itemize
1223
1224 @section Target Hardware Setup
1225
1226 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1227 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1228 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1229 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1230 working with.}
1231
1232 Common issues include:
1233
1234 @itemize @bullet
1235
1236 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1237 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1238 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1239 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1240 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1241 or one from a daughtercard).
1242 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1243 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1244
1245 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1246 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1247 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1248 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1249 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1250 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1251
1252 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1253 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1254 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1255 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1256 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1257
1258
1259 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1260 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1261 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1262 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1263 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1264 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1265 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1266
1267 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1268 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1269 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1270 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1271 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1272
1273 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1274 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1275 used to start booting.
1276
1277 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1278 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1279 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1280 multiple audio codec chips).
1281 This interacts with software
1282 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1283 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1284 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1285 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1286 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1287 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1288 audio or video codecs are used.
1289
1290 @end itemize
1291
1292 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1293 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1294 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1295 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1296 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1297 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1298 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1299 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1300 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1301 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1302
1303
1304 @node Config File Guidelines
1305 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1306
1307 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1308 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1309 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1310 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1311
1312 You should find the following directories under
1313 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1314 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1315 @itemize @bullet
1316 @item @file{interface} ...
1317 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1318 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1319 @item @file{board} ...
1320 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1321 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1322
1323 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1324 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1325 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1326 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1327 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1328 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1329 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1330 a CPU and an FPGA.
1331 @item @file{target} ...
1332 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1333 on a chip
1334 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1335 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1336 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1337 the target config file defines all of them.
1338 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1339 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1340 @end itemize
1341
1342 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1343 file may override features in any of the above files by
1344 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1345 commands specific to their situation.
1346
1347 @section Interface Config Files
1348
1349 The user config file
1350 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1351
1352 @example
1353 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1354 @end example
1355
1356 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1357 in use today with OpenOCD.
1358 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1359 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1360
1361 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1362 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1363 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1364 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1365 and need to provide a driver for it.
1366
1367 @section Board Config Files
1368 @cindex config file, board
1369 @cindex board config file
1370
1371 The user config file
1372 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1373
1374 @example
1375 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1376 @end example
1377
1378 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1379 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1380 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1381
1382 @enumerate
1383 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1384 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1385 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1386 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1387 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1388 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1389 @end enumerate
1390
1391 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1392 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1393 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1394 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1395
1396 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1397 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1398 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1399 configuration works.
1400
1401 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1402
1403 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1404 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1405 convention on how to use certain variables.
1406
1407 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1408 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1409 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1410 used at will within a target configuration file.
1411
1412 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1413 for a board with three chips:
1414
1415 @example
1416 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1417 set CHIPNAME network
1418 set ENDIAN big
1419 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1420 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1421 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1422 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1423
1424 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1425 set CHIPNAME video
1426 set ENDIAN little
1427 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1428 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1429 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1430 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1431
1432 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1433 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1434 unset ENDIAN
1435 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1436 @end example
1437
1438 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1439 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1440 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1441 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1442 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1443 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1444 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1445 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1446
1447 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1448 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1449 naming collisions.
1450
1451 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1452 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1453 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1454 up other clocks and peripherals.
1455
1456 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1457 @cindex variable names
1458
1459 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1460 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1461 one such chip (as shown above).
1462 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1463 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1464 to promote consistency and
1465 so that board files can override target defaults.
1466
1467 Inputs to target config files include:
1468
1469 @itemize @bullet
1470 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1471 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1472 tap identifier dotted names.
1473 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1474 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1475 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1476 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1477 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1478 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1479 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1480 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1481 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1482 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1483 @end itemize
1484
1485 Outputs from target config files include:
1486
1487 @itemize @bullet
1488 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1489 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1490 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1491 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1492 specific to that board and that target.
1493 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1494 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1495 @end itemize
1496
1497 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1498 @cindex event, reset-init
1499 @cindex reset-init handler
1500
1501 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1502 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1503 fully set up yet.
1504 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1505 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1506 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1507 handler is one of the most important.
1508
1509 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1510 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1511 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1512 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1513 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1514
1515 @quotation Note
1516 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1517 are included here.
1518 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1519 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1520 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1521 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1522 @end quotation
1523
1524 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1525 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1526 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1527 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1528 those as parameters.
1529 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1530 and disabling the watchdog.
1531 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1532 the next developer doing such work.
1533 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1534
1535 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1536 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1537 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1538 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1539
1540 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1541
1542 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1543 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1544 a low JTAG clock rate.
1545 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1546 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1547 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1548 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1549 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1550 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1551 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1552
1553 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1554 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1555 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1556 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1557 which might be less than that.
1558
1559 @quotation Warning
1560 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1561 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1562 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1563 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1564 @end quotation
1565
1566 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1567 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1568 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1569 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1570 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1571 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1572
1573 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1574 @subsection The init_board procedure
1575 @cindex init_board procedure
1576
1577 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1578 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1579 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1580 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1581 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1582 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1583 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1584 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1585 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1586 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1587 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1588 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1589
1590 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1591 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1592
1593 @example
1594 ### board_file.cfg ###
1595
1596 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1597 source [find target/target.cfg]
1598
1599 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1600 # enables fast on-board clock source
1601 # configures the chip to use it
1602 @}
1603
1604 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1605 proc init_board @{@} @{
1606 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1607
1608 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1609 adapter speed 100
1610 @}
1611
1612 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1613 enable_fast_clock
1614 adapter speed 10000
1615 @}
1616 @}
1617 @end example
1618
1619 @section Target Config Files
1620 @cindex config file, target
1621 @cindex target config file
1622
1623 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1624 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1625 more target config files like this:
1626
1627 @example
1628 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1629 @end example
1630
1631 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1632 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1633 In summary the target files should contain
1634
1635 @enumerate
1636 @item Set defaults
1637 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1638 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1639 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1640 @item On-Chip flash
1641 @end enumerate
1642
1643 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1644 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1645 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1646
1647 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1648 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1649 can talk to the chip.
1650 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1651 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1652 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1653 and other processing engines.
1654
1655 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1656
1657 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1658 letting board config files express environment-specific
1659 differences in how things should be set up.
1660
1661 @example
1662 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1663 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1664 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1665 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1666 @} else @{
1667 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1668 @}
1669
1670 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1671 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1672 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1673 @} else @{
1674 set _ENDIAN little
1675 @}
1676
1677 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1678 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1679 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1680 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1681 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1682 @} else @{
1683 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1684 @}
1685 @end example
1686 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1687
1688 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1689 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1690 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1691
1692 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1693 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1694 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1695
1696 @example
1697 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1698 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1699 @end example
1700
1701 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1702 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1703 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1704 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1705 for taps.
1706
1707 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1708 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1709 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1710 looks (in part) like this:
1711
1712 @example
1713 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1714 @end example
1715
1716 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1717 to source such a config file twice, with different
1718 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1719 it adds a different TAP each time.
1720
1721 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1722 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1723 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1724 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1725
1726 @example
1727 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1728 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1729 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1730 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1731 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1732 @end example
1733
1734 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1735 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1736
1737 @itemize
1738 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1739 plus a JRC to enable them
1740 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1741 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1742 is not currently used)
1743 @end itemize
1744
1745 @subsection Add CPU targets
1746
1747 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1748 GDB and other commands can use it.
1749 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1750 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1751 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1752 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1753
1754 @example
1755 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1756 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1757 @end example
1758
1759 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1760 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1761 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1762 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1763 a work area if you can.
1764 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1765
1766 @example
1767 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1768 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1769 @end example
1770
1771 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1772 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1773 @cindex SMP
1774 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1775
1776 @example
1777 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1778 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1779 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1780 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1781 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1782 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1783 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1784 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1785 @end example
1786 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1787 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1788 @itemize @bullet
1789 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1790 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1791 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1792 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1793 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1794 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1795 @end itemize
1796
1797 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1798 command have been implemented.
1799 @itemize @bullet
1800 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1801 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1802 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1803 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1804 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1805 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1806 following example.
1807 @end itemize
1808
1809 @example
1810 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1811 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1812 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1813 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1815 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1816 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1820 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1821 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1824 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1825 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1826 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1827 @end example
1828
1829
1830 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1831
1832 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1833 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1834 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1835
1836 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1837 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1838 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1839 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1840 both signals.
1841
1842 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1843 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1844 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1845 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1846 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1847 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1848 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1849 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1850 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1851 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1852 not available.)
1853
1854 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1855 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1856 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1857 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1858 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1859 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1860 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1861 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1862
1863 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1864 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1865 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1866 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1867 slower clock than they will use later.
1868 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1869 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1870 than they will use later.
1871 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1872
1873 @quotation Important
1874 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1875 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1876 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1877 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1878 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1879 @end quotation
1880
1881 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1882 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1883 @cindex init_targets procedure
1884
1885 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1886 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1887 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1888 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1889 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1890 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1891 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1892 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1893 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1894
1895 @example
1896 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1897
1898 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1899 # basic initialization procedure ...
1900 @}
1901
1902 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1903 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1904 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1905 @}
1906
1907 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1908
1909 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1910
1911 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1912 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1913 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1914 @}
1915 @end example
1916
1917 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1918 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1919
1920 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1921
1922 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1923 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1924
1925 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1926 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1927 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1928
1929 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1930 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1931 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1932 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1933 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1934 events already assigned.
1935
1936 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1937
1938 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1939 special high speed download features - enable it.
1940
1941 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1942
1943 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1944 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1945 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1946 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1947 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1948 If you are using an external trace port,
1949 configure it in your board config file.
1950 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1951 configure it in your target config file.
1952
1953 @example
1954 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1955 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1956 @end example
1957
1958 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1959
1960 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1961
1962 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1963 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1964 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1965 the TARGET (chip) file.
1966
1967 Examples:
1968 @itemize @bullet
1969 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1970 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1971 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1972 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1973 @end itemize
1974
1975 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1976 @section Translating Configuration Files
1977 @cindex translation
1978 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1979 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1980 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1981 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1982 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1983 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1984
1985 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1986 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1987 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1988 convert other scripts later on.
1989
1990 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1991 replace job:
1992
1993 @example
1994 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1995 #
1996 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1997 #
1998 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1999 #
2000 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2001
2002 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2003 global TARGETNAME
2004
2005 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2006
2007 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2008 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2009 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2010 @}
2011 @end example
2012
2013
2014
2015 @node Server Configuration
2016 @chapter Server Configuration
2017 @cindex initialization
2018 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2019 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2020 supported.
2021
2022 @anchor{configurationstage}
2023 @section Configuration Stage
2024 @cindex configuration stage
2025 @cindex config command
2026
2027 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2028 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2029 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2030 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2031 inside startup scripts.
2032
2033 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2034 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2035 which may be issued interactively.
2036 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2037 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2038
2039 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2040 flash banks,
2041 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2042 and other basic setup.
2043 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2044 may access or activate TAPs.
2045 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2046 longer be issued.
2047
2048 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2049 @section Entering the Run Stage
2050
2051 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2052 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2053 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2054 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2055 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2056 You should see no errors at this point.
2057 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2058 commands you used to configure the server.
2059 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2060 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2061 on the scan chain.
2062
2063 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2064 become available.
2065 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2066 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2067 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2068 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2069 entry to the run stage.
2070
2071 @deffn {Config Command} init
2072 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2073 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2074 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2075 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2076 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2077 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2078
2079 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2080 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2081 configuration files and/or command line options.
2082
2083 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2084 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2085 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2086 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2087 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2088 @end deffn
2089
2090 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2091 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2092 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2093
2094 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2095 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2096 scan chain.
2097 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2098 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2099
2100 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2101 they return.
2102 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2103 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2104 @end deffn
2105
2106 @anchor{tcpipports}
2107 @section TCP/IP Ports
2108 @cindex TCP port
2109 @cindex server
2110 @cindex port
2111 @cindex security
2112 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2113 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2114 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2115
2116 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2117 access using one or more of these ports.
2118 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2119 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2120 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2121
2122 @anchor{gdb_port}
2123 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2124 @cindex GDB server
2125 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2126 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2127 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2128 the normal use cases.
2129
2130 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2131 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2132 disables the gdb server.
2133
2134 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2135 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2136
2137 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2138 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2139
2140 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2141 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2142 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2143
2144 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2145 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2146 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2147 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2148 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2149 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2150 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2151 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2152 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2153
2154 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2155 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2156 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2157 @end deffn
2158
2159 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2160 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2161 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2162 output from the Tcl engine.
2163 Intended as a machine interface.
2164 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2165 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2166 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2167 @end deffn
2168
2169 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2170 Specify or query the
2171 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2172 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2173 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2174 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2175 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2176 @end deffn
2177
2178 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2179 @section GDB Configuration
2180 @cindex GDB
2181 @cindex GDB configuration
2182 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2183 The ones listed here are static and global.
2184 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2185 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2186
2187 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2188 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2189 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2190 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2191 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2192 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2193 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2197 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2198 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2199 vFlash packet is received.
2200 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @end deffn
2202
2203 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2204 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2205 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2206 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2207 for flash programming to work.
2208 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2209 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2210 @end deffn
2211
2212 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2213 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2214 by GDB memory read packets.
2215 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2216 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2217 @end deffn
2218
2219 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2220 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2221 packets report errors or not.
2222 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2223 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2227 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2228 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2229 @end deffn
2230
2231 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2232 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2233
2234 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2235 @end deffn
2236
2237 @anchor{eventpolling}
2238 @section Event Polling
2239
2240 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2241 where significant events can happen at any time.
2242 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2243 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2244 or to GDB.
2245
2246 Examples of such events include:
2247
2248 @itemize
2249 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2250 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2251 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2252 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2253 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2254 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2255 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2256 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2257 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2258 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2259 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2260 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2261 @end itemize
2262
2263 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2264 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2265 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2266 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2267 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2268
2269 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2270 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2271 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2272 to the various active targets.
2273 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2274 which is normally done in the background.
2275
2276 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2277 Poll the current target for its current state.
2278 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2279 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2280 specific information about the current state is printed.
2281 An optional parameter
2282 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2283
2284 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2285 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2286 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2287 @example
2288 > poll
2289 background polling: on
2290 target state: halted
2291 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2292 current mode: Supervisor
2293 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2294 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2295 >
2296 @end example
2297 @end deffn
2298
2299 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2300 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2301 @cindex config file, interface
2302 @cindex interface config file
2303
2304 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2305 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2306 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2307
2308 @quotation Note
2309 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2310 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2311 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2312 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2313 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2314 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2315 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2316 @end quotation
2317
2318 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2319 through commands in an interface configuration
2320 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2321 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2322
2323 @example
2324 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2325 @end example
2326
2327 These commands tell
2328 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2329 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2330
2331 @example
2332 # jlink interface
2333 adapter driver jlink
2334 @end example
2335
2336 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2337
2338
2339 @section Adapter Configuration
2340
2341 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2342 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2343 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2344
2345 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2346 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2347 target.
2348 @end deffn
2349
2350 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2351 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2352 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2353 @end deffn
2354 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2355 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2356 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2357 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2358 the hardware can support.
2359 @end deffn
2360
2361
2362
2363 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2364 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2365 @end deffn
2366
2367 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2368 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2369 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2370 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2371 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2372 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2373 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2374
2375 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @section Interface Drivers
2379
2380 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2381 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2382 available at run time.
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2385 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2386 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2387 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2390 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2391 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2395 Displays status of RTCK option.
2396 Optionally sets that option first.
2397 @end deffn
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2401 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2402 This has one driver-specific command:
2403
2404 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2405 Logs some status
2406 @end deffn
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2410 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2411 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2412 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2413 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2414 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2418 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2419
2420 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2421 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2422 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2423 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2424 @example
2425 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2426 @end example
2427 @end deffn
2428
2429 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2430 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2431 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2435 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2436 @end deffn
2437 @end deffn
2438
2439 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2440 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2441 @end deffn
2442
2443 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2444 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2448 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2449 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2450
2451 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2452 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2453
2454 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2455 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2456
2457 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2458 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2459 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2460 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2461 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2462 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2463
2464 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2465 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2466 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2467 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2468 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2469
2470 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2471 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2472 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2473 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2474
2475 @itemize @minus
2476 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2477 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2478 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2479 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2480 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2481 switching data and direction as necessary
2482 @end itemize
2483
2484 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2485 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2486
2487 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2488 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2489 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2490 @example
2491 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2492 @end example
2493 @end deffn
2494
2495 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2496 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2497 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2498 during device selection.
2499 @end deffn
2500
2501 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2502 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2503 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2504 is connected to the host.
2505 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2506 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2507 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2508 @end deffn
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2511 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2512 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2513
2514 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2515 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2516 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2517 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2518 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2519
2520 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2521 @end deffn
2522
2523 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2524 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2525 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2529 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2530 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2531 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2532 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2533 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2534 and initially asserted reset signals.
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2538 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2539 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2540 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2541 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2542 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2543 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2544 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2545 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2546 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2547 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2548
2549 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2550 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2551 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2552 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2553 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2554 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2555
2556 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2557 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2558 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2559 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2560 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2561 are always driven by the FTDI.
2562
2563 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2564 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2565 @var{name}.
2566 @end deffn
2567
2568 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2569 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2570 @itemize @minus
2571 @item @option{0}, drive low
2572 @item @option{1}, drive high
2573 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2574 @end itemize
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2578 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2579 @end deffn
2580
2581 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2582 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2583
2584 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2585 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2586 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2587 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2588 @itemize @minus
2589 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2590 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2591 @end itemize
2592 @end deffn
2593
2594 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2595 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2596
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2600 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2601 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2602 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2603
2604 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2605 @itemize @minus
2606 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2607 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2608 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2609 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2610 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2611 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2612 @end itemize
2613
2614 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2615 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2616 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2617 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2618 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2619 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2620 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2621 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2622
2623 FT232R
2624 @itemize @minus
2625 @item bit 7 - RI
2626 @item bit 6 - DCD
2627 @item bit 5 - DSR
2628 @item bit 4 - DTR
2629 @item bit 3 - CTS
2630 @item bit 2 - RTS
2631 @item bit 1 - RXD
2632 @item bit 0 - TXD
2633 @end itemize
2634
2635 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2636 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2639 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2640 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2644 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2645 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2646 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2650 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2651 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2655 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2659 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2663 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2667 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2668 @end deffn
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2671 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2675 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2679 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2680 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2681 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2682 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2683 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2684 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2685 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2686 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2687 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2693 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2694 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2695 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2696
2697 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2698 processors which are being simulated.
2699
2700 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2701 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2702 sockets instead of TCP.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2706 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2707 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2711 something like:
2712
2713 @example
2714 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2715 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2716 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2717 @end example
2718
2719 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2720 named mysocket:
2721
2722 @example
2723 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2724 remote_bitbang_port 0
2725 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2726 @end example
2727 @end deffn
2728
2729 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2730 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2731 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2732 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2733
2734 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2735 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2736 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2737 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2738 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2742 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2743 default values are used.
2744 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2745 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2746 @example
2747 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2748 @end example
2749 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2750 @example
2751 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2752 @end example
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2756 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2757 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2758 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2759 target board.
2760
2761 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2762 @example
2763 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2764 reset_config srst_only
2765 @end example
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2769 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2770 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2771 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2775 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2776 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2782 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2783 This has one driver-specific command:
2784
2785 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2786 Display either the address of the I/O port
2787 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2788 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2789 This is a write-once setting.
2790 @end deffn
2791 @end deffn
2792
2793 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2794 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2795 transports.
2796
2797 @quotation Compatibility Note
2798 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2799 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2800 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2801 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2802 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2803 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2804 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2805 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2806 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2807 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2808 @end quotation
2809
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2811 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2812 states.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2815 Display free device internal memory.
2816 @end deffn
2817 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2818 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2819 command version.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2822 Display the device configuration.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2825 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2826 power state.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2829 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2832 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2833 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2834 IP configuration.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2837 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2838 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2841 Reset the current configuration.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2844 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2847 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2851 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2852 @example
2853 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2857 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2858 pairs.
2859
2860 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2861 @example
2862 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2863 77a90000
2864 @end example
2865 @end deffn
2866 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2867 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2868 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2869 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2870 instead.
2871
2872 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2873 @end deffn
2874 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2875 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2876 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2877
2878 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2879 @end deffn
2880 @end deffn
2881
2882 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2883 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2884 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2885 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2886 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2887 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2888 configuration script.
2889
2890 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2891 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2892 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2893 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2894 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2895
2896 Known limitations:
2897 @itemize @bullet
2898 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2899 and 2.7 MHz.
2900 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2901 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2902 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2903 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2904 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2905 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2906 communications with the target.
2907 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2908 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2909 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2910 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2911 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2912 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2913 @end itemize
2914
2915 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2916 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2917 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2921 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2922 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2926 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2927 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2928 target as a side-effect.
2929 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2933 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2934 version, and target voltage.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2939 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2940 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2941 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2942 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2943
2944 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2945 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2946 This is a write-once setting.
2947 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2948
2949 @itemize @minus
2950 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2951 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2952 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2953 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2954 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2955 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2956 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2957 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2958 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2959 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2960 some versions of
2961 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2962 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2963 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2964 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2965 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2966 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2967 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2968 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2969 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2970 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2971 @end itemize
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2975 Display either the address of the I/O port
2976 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2977 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2978 This is a write-once setting.
2979
2980 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2981 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2982 you may encounter a problem.
2983 @end deffn
2984
2985 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2986 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2987 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2988 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2989 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2990 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2991
2992 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2993 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2994 @quotation Tip
2995 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2996 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2997 @example
2998 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2999 > adapter speed 500
3000 @end example
3001 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3002 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3003 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3004 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3005 large set of samples.
3006 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3007 @example
3008 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3009 @end example
3010 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3011 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3012
3013 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3014 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3015 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3016 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3017 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3018 be conservative.
3019 @end quotation
3020 @end deffn
3021
3022 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3023 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3024 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3025 @end deffn
3026
3027 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3028 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3029
3030 @example
3031 adapter driver parport
3032 parport_port 0x278
3033 parport_cable wiggler
3034 @end example
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3038 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3039 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3040 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3041 @end deffn
3042 @end deffn
3043
3044 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3045 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3046 @end deffn
3047
3048 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3049 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3053 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3054
3055 @quotation Note
3056 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3057 which are not currently documented here.
3058 @end quotation
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061 @anchor{hla_interface}
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3063 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3064 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3065 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3066
3067 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3068 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3069 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3070 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3071 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3072
3073 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3074 Currently Not Supported.
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3078 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3082 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3086 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3090 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3091 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3092 @end deffn
3093 @end deffn
3094
3095 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3096 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3097 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3098 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3099 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3100
3101 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3102 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3103 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3104 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3105
3106 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3107 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3108
3109 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3110 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3114 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3115 @end deffn
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3119 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3123 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3127 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3128 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3129 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3130 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3131
3132 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3133 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3134 XDS110 found will be used.
3135 @end deffn
3136
3137 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3138 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3139 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3140 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3144 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3145 version).
3146 @end deffn
3147 @end deffn
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3150 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3151 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3152 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3153 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3154
3155 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3156
3157 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3158 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3159
3160 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3161 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3162
3163 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3164
3165 @end deffn
3166 @end deffn
3167
3168 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3169 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3170 @end deffn
3171
3172 @quotation Note
3173 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3174 which are not currently documented here.
3175 @end quotation
3176
3177 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3178 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3179 No arguments: print status.
3180 @end deffn
3181
3182 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3183 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3184 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3185
3186 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3187 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3188 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3189 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3190 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3191 configuration on exit.
3192
3193 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3194 pinout.
3195
3196 @end deffn
3197
3198 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3199 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3200 of the one which is most popular.
3201
3202 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3203
3204 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3205 pinout.
3206
3207 @end deffn
3208
3209
3210 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3211 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3212 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3213
3214 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3215 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3216 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3217
3218 @itemize @minus
3219 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3220 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3221 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3222 @end itemize
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3226 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3227 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3228 @end deffn
3229 @end deffn
3230
3231 @section Transport Configuration
3232 @cindex Transport
3233 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3234 and the debug adapter you are using,
3235 several transports may be available to
3236 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3237 @deffn Command {transport list}
3238 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3239 version of OpenOCD.
3240 @end deffn
3241
3242 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3243 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3244
3245 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3246 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3247 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3248 adapter's driver).
3249
3250 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3251 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3252 supported by the debug adapter.
3253
3254 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3255 transport, if any.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @subsection JTAG Transport
3259 @cindex JTAG
3260 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3261 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3262 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3263 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3264 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3265 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3266
3267 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3268 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3269 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3270 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3271 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3272
3273 @subsection SWD Transport
3274 @cindex SWD
3275 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3276 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3277 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3278 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3279 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3280 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3281 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3282
3283 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3284 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3285 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3286 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3287 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3288
3289 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3290 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3291 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3292 expected to change.
3293 @end deffn
3294 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3295 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3296 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3297 No parameters: displays current settings.
3298 @end deffn
3299
3300 @subsection SPI Transport
3301 @cindex SPI
3302 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3303 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3304 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3305 solution for flash programming.
3306
3307 @anchor{swimtransport}
3308 @subsection SWIM Transport
3309 @cindex SWIM
3310 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3311 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3312 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3313 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3314
3315 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3316
3317 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3318
3319 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3320 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3321 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3322 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3323 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3324
3325 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3326 @section JTAG Speed
3327 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3328 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3329 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3330 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3331 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3332 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3333 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3334 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3335 power management software that may be active.
3336
3337 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3338 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3339 target event handler.
3340 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3341 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3342 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3343 sets up those clocks).
3344 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3345 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3346 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3347 in the target config file.
3348 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3349 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3350 config file instead.
3351 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3352 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3353 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3354
3355 @example
3356 jtag_rclk 3000
3357 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3358 @end example
3359
3360 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3361 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3362 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3363 may not be the fastest solution.
3364
3365 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3366 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3367 which support adaptive clocking.
3368
3369 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3370 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3371 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3372 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3373 than the speed specified.
3374
3375 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3376 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3377 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3378 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3379
3380 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3381 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3382 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3383 JTAG clocking after setup.
3384 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3385 If the interface device can not
3386 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3387 @end deffn
3388
3389 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3390 @cindex adaptive clocking
3391 @cindex RTCK
3392 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3393 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3394 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3395 @example
3396 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3397 jtag_rclk 3000
3398 @end example
3399 @end defun
3400
3401 @node Reset Configuration
3402 @chapter Reset Configuration
3403 @cindex Reset Configuration
3404
3405 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3406 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3407 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3408 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3409 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3410 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3411 Please see the various board files for examples.
3412
3413 @quotation Note
3414 To maintainers and integrators:
3415 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3416 Normally the board configuration file
3417 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3418 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3419
3420 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3421 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3422 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3423 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3424 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3425 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3426 @end quotation
3427
3428 @section Types of Reset
3429
3430 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3431 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3432 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3433
3434 @itemize @bullet
3435 @item
3436 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3437 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3438 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3439 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3440 @item
3441 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3442 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3443 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3444 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3445 @item
3446 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3447 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3448 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3449 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3450 @item
3451 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3452 several other types of reset.
3453 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3454 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3455 There may be individual module resets.
3456 @end itemize
3457
3458 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3459 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3460 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3461 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3462 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3463 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3464 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3465 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3466 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3467
3468 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3469 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3470
3471 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3472 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3473 common issues are:
3474
3475 @itemize @bullet
3476
3477 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3478 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3479 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3480 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3481 when either of those signals is not connected.
3482 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3483 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3484 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3485 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3486
3487 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3488 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3489 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3490 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3491
3492 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3493 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3494 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3495 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3496 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3497 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3498 hardware debouncing.
3499 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3500 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3501
3502 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3503 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3504 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3505 to use push/pull output drivers.
3506 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3507 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3508 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3509 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3510
3511 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3512 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3513 issues (not limited to errata).
3514 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3515 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3516 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3517 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3518 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3519 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3520 @end itemize
3521
3522 There can also be other issues.
3523 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3524 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3525 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3526 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3527 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3528 Agreement (NDA).
3529
3530 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3531 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3532 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3533
3534 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3535 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3536
3537 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3538
3539 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3540 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3541 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3542 allowing it to be deasserted.
3543 @end deffn
3544
3545 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3546 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3547 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3548 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3549 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3550 @end deffn
3551
3552 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3553 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3554 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3555 allowing it to be deasserted.
3556 @end deffn
3557
3558 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3559 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3560 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3561 @end deffn
3562
3563 @anchor{reset_config}
3564 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3565 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3566 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3567 configuration scripts.
3568
3569 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3570 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3571 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3572 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3573 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3574 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3575 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3576 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3577
3578 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3579 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3580 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3581 -- may be specified at a time.
3582 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3583 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3584 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3585 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3586 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3587
3588 @itemize
3589 @item
3590 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3591 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3592 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3593 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3594 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3595
3596 @quotation Tip
3597 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3598 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3599 @end quotation
3600
3601 @item
3602 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3603 signal implementations.
3604 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3605 indicating everything behaves normally.
3606 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3607 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3608 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3609 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3610 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3611 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3612 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3613
3614 @item
3615 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3616 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3617 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3618 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3619 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3620 while SRST is asserted.
3621 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3622 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3623
3624 @item
3625 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3626 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3627 is required to use this option.
3628 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3629 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3630 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3631 be asserted before any target connection.
3632 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3633 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3634 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3635 @end itemize
3636
3637 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3638 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3639 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3640 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3641 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3642
3643 @itemize
3644 @item
3645 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3646 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3647 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3648 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3649
3650 @item
3651 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3652 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3653 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3654 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3655 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3656 @end itemize
3657 @end deffn
3658
3659 @section Custom Reset Handling
3660 @cindex events
3661
3662 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3663 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3664 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3665 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3666 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3667 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3668
3669 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3670 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3671 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3672 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3673 want to reset everything at once.
3674
3675 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3676 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3677 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3678 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3679 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3680 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3681 needs special attention.
3682
3683 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3684 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3685 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3686 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3687 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3688 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3689 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3690 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3691 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3692
3693 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3694 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3695 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3696 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3697 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3698
3699 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3700 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3701 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3702 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3703 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3704 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3705 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3706 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3707 or potentially some other value.
3708
3709 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3710 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3711 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3712 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3713 (or their associated targets)
3714 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3715
3716 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3717 they return.
3718 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3719 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3720 @end deffn
3721
3722 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3723 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3724 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3725 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3726 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3727 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3728 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3729 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3730 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3731 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3732 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3733 @end deffn
3734
3735 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3736 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3737 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3738 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3739 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3740 @end deffn
3741
3742
3743 @node TAP Declaration
3744 @chapter TAP Declaration
3745 @cindex TAP declaration
3746 @cindex TAP configuration
3747
3748 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3749 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3750
3751 @itemize @bullet
3752 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3753 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3754 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3755 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3756 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3757 start running that code.
3758 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3759 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3760 and missing connections.
3761 @end itemize
3762
3763 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3764 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3765 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3766 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3767 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3768
3769 @section Scan Chains
3770 @cindex scan chain
3771
3772 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3773 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3774 They also need to be added to
3775 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3776 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3777 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3778 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3779 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3780 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3781 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3782 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3783
3784 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3785 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3786 command, presented in the next chapter.
3787 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3788 debugging targets.)
3789 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3790
3791 @verbatim
3792 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3793 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3794 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3795 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3796 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3797 @end verbatim
3798
3799 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3800 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3801 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3802 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3803 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3804 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3805 until they are told to do so.
3806
3807 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3808 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3809 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3810 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3811
3812 @example
3813 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3814 @end example
3815
3816 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3817 by a given chip.
3818 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3819 and so forth.
3820 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3821 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3822 both inside a single chip and between them.
3823 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3824
3825 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3826 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3827 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3828 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3829 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3830 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3831 includes commands something like this:
3832
3833 @example
3834 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3835 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3836 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3837 @end example
3838
3839 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3840 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3841 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3842
3843 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3844 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3845 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3846 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3847 @example
3848 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3849 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3850 @}
3851 @end example
3852 @end deffn
3853
3854 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3855 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3856 and their status.
3857 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3858 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3859 but systems with a JTAG router can
3860 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3861 @end deffn
3862
3863 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3864 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3865
3866 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3867 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3868
3869 @section TAP Names
3870 @cindex dotted name
3871
3872 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3873 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3874 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3875 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3876 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3877 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3878 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3879 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3880
3881 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3882 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3883 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3884
3885 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3886
3887 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3888 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3889 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3890 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3891
3892 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3893 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3894 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3895 overridable.
3896
3897 @cindex TAP naming convention
3898 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3899 and should follow this convention:
3900
3901 @itemize @bullet
3902 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3903 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3904 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3905 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3906 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3907 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3908 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3909 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3910 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3911 with a single TAP;
3912 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3913 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3914 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3915 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3916 @end itemize
3917
3918 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3919
3920 @itemize @bullet
3921 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3922 @*The length in bits of the
3923 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3924 @end itemize
3925
3926 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3927
3928 @itemize @bullet
3929 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3930 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3931 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3932 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3933 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3934 (the TAP is linked in).
3935 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3936 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3937 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3938 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3939 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3940 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3941 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3942 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3943 values that were found but not included in the list.
3944
3945 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3946 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3947 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3948 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3949 hardware to find these values.
3950 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3951 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3952 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3953 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3954 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3955 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3956 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3957 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3958 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3959 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3960 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3961 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3962 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3963 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3964 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3965 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3966 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3967 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3968 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3969 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3970 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3971 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3972 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3973 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3974 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3975 @end itemize
3976 @end deffn
3977
3978 @section Other TAP commands
3979
3980 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3981 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3982 @end deffn
3983
3984 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3985 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3986 At this writing this TAP attribute
3987 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3988 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3989 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3990 See the next section for information about the available events.
3991
3992 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3993 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3994 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3995 @end deffn
3996
3997 @section TAP Events
3998 @cindex events
3999 @cindex TAP events
4000
4001 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4002 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4003 The other applies to debugger targets,
4004 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4005
4006 The TAP events currently defined are:
4007
4008 @itemize @bullet
4009 @item @b{post-reset}
4010 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4011 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4012 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4013 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4014 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4015
4016 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4017 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4018 of any particular target.
4019 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4020 @item @b{setup}
4021 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4022 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4023 @item @b{tap-disable}
4024 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4025 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4026 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4027 @item @b{tap-enable}
4028 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4029 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4030 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4031 @end itemize
4032
4033 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4034 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4035 contents to be accurate), you might:
4036
4037 @example
4038 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4039 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4040 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4041 @}
4042 @end example
4043
4044
4045 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4046 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4047 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4048 @cindex jrc
4049
4050 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4051 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4052 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4053 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4054 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4055
4056 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4057 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4058 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4059 be visible.
4060 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4061 ignores, such as:
4062
4063 @itemize
4064 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4065 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4066 TAPs receive new instructions.
4067 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4068 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4069 @end itemize
4070
4071 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4072 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4073 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4074 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4075
4076 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4077 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4078
4079 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4080 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4081 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4082 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4083 should define TAP event handlers using
4084 code that looks something like this:
4085
4086 @example
4087 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4088 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4089 @}
4090 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4091 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4092 @}
4093 @end example
4094
4095 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4096
4097 @example
4098 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4099 @end example
4100
4101 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4102 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4103 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4104 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4105
4106 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4107 If necessary, disables the tap
4108 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4109 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4110 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4111 and "0" if it is disabled.
4112 @end deffn
4113
4114 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4115 If necessary, enables the tap
4116 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4117 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4118 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4119 and "0" if it is disabled.
4120 @end deffn
4121
4122 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4123 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4124 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4125 and "0" if it is disabled.
4126
4127 @quotation Note
4128 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4129 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4130 @end quotation
4131 @end deffn
4132
4133 @anchor{autoprobing}
4134 @section Autoprobing
4135 @cindex autoprobe
4136 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4137
4138 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4139 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4140 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4141 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4142
4143 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4144 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4145 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4146 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4147 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4148 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4149 right when they come out of reset).
4150
4151 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4152
4153 @example
4154 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4155 reset_config trst_and_srst
4156 jtag_rclk 8
4157 @end example
4158
4159 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4160 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4161
4162 @enumerate
4163 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4164 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4165 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4166 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4167 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4168 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4169 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4170 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4171 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4172 that is discovered.
4173 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4174 register, it will report it.
4175 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4176 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4177 @end enumerate
4178
4179 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4180 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4181 that's a bit more complex:
4182
4183 @example
4184 clock speed 8 kHz
4185 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4186 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4187 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4188 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4189 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4190 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4191 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4192 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4193 @end example
4194
4195 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4196 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4197 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4198 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4199 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4200 and so forth.
4201
4202 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4203 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4204 @cindex DAP declaration
4205
4206 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4207 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4208 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4209 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4210 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4211
4212 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4213
4214 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4215 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4216 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4217 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4218 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4219
4220 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4221
4222 @itemize @bullet
4223 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4224 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4225 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4226 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4227 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4228 @end itemize
4229 @end deffn
4230
4231 @deffn Command {dap names}
4232 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4233 for TCL scripting.
4234 @end deffn
4235
4236 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4237 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4238 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4239 @end deffn
4240
4241 @deffn Command {dap init}
4242 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4243 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4244 initialization, too.
4245 @end deffn
4246
4247 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4248
4249 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4250 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4251 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4252 @end deffn
4253
4254 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4255 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4256 @end deffn
4257
4258 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4259 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4260 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4261 or set a new value @var{value}.
4262 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4263 @end deffn
4264
4265 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4266 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4267 @end deffn
4268
4269 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4270 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4271 value @var{value}.
4272
4273 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4274 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4275 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4276
4277 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4278 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4279 @end deffn
4280
4281 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4282 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4283 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4287 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4288 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4289 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4290 @end deffn
4291
4292 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4293 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4294
4295 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4296 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4297 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4298 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4299 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4300 for details.
4301
4302 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4303 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4304 the pattern:
4305 @example
4306 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4307 @end example
4308
4309 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4310 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4311 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4312 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4313 @example
4314 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4315 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4316 @end example
4317
4318 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4319 @example
4320 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4321 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4322 @end example
4323
4324 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4325 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4326
4327 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4328 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4329 example with a proper dap name:
4330 @example
4331 xxx.dap apcsw default
4332 @end example
4333 @end deffn
4334
4335 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4336 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4337 Disabled by default
4338 @end deffn
4339
4340
4341 @node CPU Configuration
4342 @chapter CPU Configuration
4343 @cindex GDB target
4344
4345 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4346 You can also access these targets without GDB
4347 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4348 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4349 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4350 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4351
4352 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4353 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4354
4355 @section Target List
4356 @cindex target, current
4357 @cindex target, list
4358
4359 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4360 where each member has a name.
4361 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4362 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4363 (plural!) command.
4364 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4365 look like with more than one:
4366 @verbatim
4367 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4368 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4369 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4370 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4371 @end verbatim
4372
4373 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4374 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4375 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4376 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4377 space seen by that current target.
4378 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4379 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4380 are examples; and there are many more.
4381
4382 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4383
4384 @deffn Command {target current}
4385 Returns the name of the current target.
4386 @end deffn
4387
4388 @deffn Command {target names}
4389 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4390 @example
4391 foreach t [target names] @{
4392 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4393 @}
4394 @end example
4395 @end deffn
4396
4397 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4398 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4399
4400 @deffn Command targets [name]
4401 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4402 command names are singular.}
4403
4404 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4405 targets in a user friendly form.
4406
4407 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4408 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4409 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4410 @end deffn
4411
4412 @section Target CPU Types
4413 @cindex target type
4414 @cindex CPU type
4415
4416 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4417 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4418 when calling @command{target create}.
4419 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4420 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4421 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4422 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4423 what core-specific commands may be available
4424 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4425 and more.
4426
4427 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4428 since there's a command to list them.
4429
4430 @anchor{targettypes}
4431 @deffn Command {target types}
4432 Lists all supported target types.
4433 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4434
4435 @itemize @bullet
4436 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4437 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4438 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4439 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4440 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4441 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4442 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4443 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4444 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4445 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4446 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4447 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4448 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4449 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4450 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4451 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4452 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4453 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4454 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4455 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4456 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4457 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4458 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4459 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4460 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4461 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4462 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4463 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4464 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4465 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4466 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4467 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4468 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4469 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4470 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4471 @itemize @minus
4472 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4473 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4474 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4475 @end itemize
4476 And two debug interfaces cores:
4477 @itemize @minus
4478 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4479 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4480 @end itemize
4481 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4482 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4483 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4484 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4485 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4486 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4487 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4488 @end itemize
4489 @end deffn
4490
4491 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4492 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4493 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4494 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4495 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4496 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4497 reflect design generations;
4498 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4499 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4500
4501 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4502 @section Target Configuration
4503
4504 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4505 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4506 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4507 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4508 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4509
4510 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4511 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4512 optional parts.
4513 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4514 command, created as part of target creation.
4515
4516 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4517 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4518 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4519 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4520 to be much more board-specific.
4521 The key steps you use might look something like this
4522
4523 @example
4524 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4525 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4526 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4527 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4528 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4529 @end example
4530
4531 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4532 on-chip SRAM.
4533 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4534 writes to target memory;
4535 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4536 GDB memory checksumming;
4537 and more.
4538
4539 @quotation Warning
4540 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4541 inaccessible when application code
4542 (such as an operating system)
4543 enables or disables the MMU.
4544 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4545 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4546 easy access to other addresses needed.
4547 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4548 @end quotation
4549
4550 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4551 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4552 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4553 controllers.
4554 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4555 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4556 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4557
4558 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4559 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4560 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4561 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4562 purposes including additional configuration.
4563
4564 @itemize @bullet
4565 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4566 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4567 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4568 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4569
4570 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4571 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4572 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4573 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4574 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4575 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4576 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4577
4578 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4579 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4580 @end itemize
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4584 The options accepted by this command may also be
4585 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4586 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4587 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4588
4589 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4590 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4591 and changing its endianness.
4592
4593 @itemize @bullet
4594
4595 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4596 used to access this target.
4597
4598 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4599 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4600 create and manage DAP instances.
4601
4602 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4603 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4604
4605 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4606 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4607 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4608 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4609 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4610 same event name assigns only one handler.
4611
4612 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4613 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4614
4615 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4616 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4617 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4618 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4619 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4620 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4621 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4622
4623 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4624 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4625 or virtual address is being used.
4626
4627 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4628 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4629
4630 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4631 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4632 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4633 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4634 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4635
4636 @anchor{rtostype}
4637 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4638 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4639 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4640 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4641 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4642
4643 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4644 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4645 access the target for debugging.
4646
4647 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4648 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4649 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4650 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4651
4652 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4653 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4654 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4655 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4656 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4657
4658 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4659 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4660 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4661 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4662 command @command{gdb_port}.
4663 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4664 @end itemize
4665 @end deffn
4666
4667 @section Other $target_name Commands
4668 @cindex object command
4669
4670 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4671 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4672
4673 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4674 Once a button is created a button
4675 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4676 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4677 configure it like this:
4678
4679 @example
4680 # Create
4681 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4682 # Modify
4683 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4684 # Query
4685 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4686 # Report
4687 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4688 @end example
4689
4690 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4691 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4692
4693 @example
4694 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4695 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4696 @end example
4697
4698 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4699
4700 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4701 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4702 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4703 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4704 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4705 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4706 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4707 They are not otherwise documented here.
4708 @end deffn
4709
4710 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4711 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4712 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4713 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4714 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4715 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4716 the target side uses raw memory.
4717
4718 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4719 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4720 The script orientation comes from working with data
4721 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4722 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4723 and neither store nor return those values.
4724
4725 @itemize
4726 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4727 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4728 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4729 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4730 @end itemize
4731 @end deffn
4732
4733 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4734 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4735 @command{$target_name configure}
4736 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4737 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4738 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4739 There are a few special cases:
4740
4741 @itemize @bullet
4742 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4743 event named @var{event_name}.
4744 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4745 two parameters.
4746 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4747 This is a special case because this is set using
4748 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4749 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4750 @end itemize
4751
4752 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4753 all the targets you might use something like this:
4754
4755 @example
4756 foreach name [target names] @{
4757 set y [$name cget -endian]
4758 set z [$name cget -type]
4759 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4760 $x $name $y $z]
4761 @}
4762 @end example
4763 @end deffn
4764
4765 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4766 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4767 Displays the current target state:
4768 @code{debug-running},
4769 @code{halted},
4770 @code{reset},
4771 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4772 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4773 @end deffn
4774
4775 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4776 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4777 currently associated with this target.
4778 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4779 @end deffn
4780
4781 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4782 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4783 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4784 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4785 @end deffn
4786
4787 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4788 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4789 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4790 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4791 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4792 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4793 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4794 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4795 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4796 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4797 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4798 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4799 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4800 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4801 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4802 @end deffn
4803
4804 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4805 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4806 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4807 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4808 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4809 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4810 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4811 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4812 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4813 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4814 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4815 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4816 @end deffn
4817
4818 @anchor{targetevents}
4819 @section Target Events
4820 @cindex target events
4821 @cindex events
4822 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4823 For example:
4824 @itemize @bullet
4825 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4826 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4827 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4828 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4829 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4830 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4831 to set up system clocks or
4832 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4833 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4834 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4835 @end itemize
4836
4837 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4838 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4839 @command{target create ... -event}.
4840
4841 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4842 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4843 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4844
4845 @example
4846 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4847 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4848 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4849 @}
4850 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4851 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4852 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4853 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4854 @}
4855 @end example
4856
4857 The following target events are defined:
4858
4859 @itemize @bullet
4860 @item @b{debug-halted}
4861 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4862 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4863 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4864 @item @b{early-halted}
4865 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4866 @item @b{examine-start}
4867 @* Before target examine is called.
4868 @item @b{examine-end}
4869 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4870 @item @b{examine-fail}
4871 @* After target examine fails.
4872 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4873 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4874 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4875 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4876 connect GDB to running target.
4877 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4878 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4879 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4880 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4881 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4882 is in RAM or read only memory.
4883 Default is @code{halt}
4884 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4885 @* When GDB disconnects
4886 @item @b{gdb-end}
4887 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4888 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4889 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4890 @code{reset init})
4891 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4892 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4893 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4894 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4895 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4896 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4897 @item @b{gdb-start}
4898 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4899 @item @b{halted}
4900 @* The target has halted
4901 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4902 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4903 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4904 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4905 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4906 @item @b{reset-assert}
4907 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4908 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4909 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4910 it instead of asserting SRST.
4911 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4912 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4913 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4914 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4915 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4916 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4917 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4918 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4919 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4920 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4921 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4922 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4923 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4924 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4925 released on the scan chain.
4926 @item @b{reset-end}
4927 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4928 @item @b{reset-init}
4929 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4930 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4931
4932 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4933 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4934 multiplexing, and so on.
4935 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4936 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4937 @item @b{reset-start}
4938 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4939 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4940
4941 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4942 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4943 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4944 @item @b{resume-start}
4945 @* Before any target is resumed
4946 @item @b{resume-end}
4947 @* After all targets have resumed
4948 @item @b{resumed}
4949 @* Target has resumed
4950 @item @b{step-start}
4951 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4952 @item @b{step-end}
4953 @* After single-step has completed
4954 @item @b{trace-config}
4955 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4956 @end itemize
4957
4958 @node Flash Commands
4959 @chapter Flash Commands
4960
4961 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4962 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4963 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4964 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4965 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4966 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4967 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4968 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4969 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4970
4971 Flash Steps:
4972 @enumerate
4973 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4974 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4975 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4976 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4977 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4978 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4979 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4980 @item GDB Flashing
4981 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4982 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4983 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4984 @end enumerate
4985
4986 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4987 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4988 so that it can't boot.
4989 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4990 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4991
4992 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4993 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4994 @cindex flash configuration
4995
4996 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4997 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4998 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4999 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5000 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5001 see the driver-specific documentation.
5002
5003 @itemize @bullet
5004 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5005 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5006 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5007 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5008 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5009 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5010 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5011 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5012 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5013 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5014 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5015 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5016 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5017 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5018 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5019 commands to the flash controller.
5020 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5021 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5022 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5023 for more information.
5024 @end itemize
5025 @quotation Note
5026 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5027 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5028 @end quotation
5029 @end deffn
5030
5031 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5032 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5033 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5034 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5035 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5036 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5037 @end deffn
5038
5039 @deffn Command {flash list}
5040 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5041 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5042 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5043 @end deffn
5044
5045 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5046 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5047 depends on the flash type.
5048 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5049 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5050 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5051 but most don't bother.
5052 @end deffn
5053
5054 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5055
5056 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5057 begins.
5058
5059 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5060 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5061 until the programming session is finished.
5062
5063 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5064 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5065
5066 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5067
5068 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5069 @cindex flash erasing
5070 @cindex flash reading
5071 @cindex flash writing
5072 @cindex flash programming
5073 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5074
5075 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5076 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5077 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5078 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5079 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5080
5081 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5082 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5083 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5084 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5085 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5086
5087 @quotation Note
5088 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5089 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5090 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5091 back to a flash bank.
5092 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5093 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5094 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5095 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5096 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5097 @end quotation
5098
5099 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5100 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5101 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5102 disabled first.
5103 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5104 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5105 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5106
5107 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5108 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5109 up to and including @var{last}.
5110 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5111 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5112 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5113 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5114 @end deffn
5115
5116 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5117 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5118 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5119 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5120 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5121 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5122 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5123 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5124 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5125 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5126 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5127 before erase starts.
5128 @end deffn
5129
5130 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5131 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5132 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5133 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5134 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5135 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5136 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5137 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5138 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5139 before issuing this command.
5140 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5141 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5142 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5143 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5144 @end deffn
5145 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5146
5147 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5148 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5149 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5150 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5151 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5152 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5153 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5154 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5155 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5156 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5157 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5158 @end deffn
5159
5160 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5161 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5162 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5163 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5164 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5165 @end deffn
5166
5167 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5168 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5169 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5170 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5171 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5172 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5173 @end deffn
5174
5175 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5176 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5177 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5178 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5179 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5180 @end deffn
5181
5182 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5183 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5184 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5185 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5186 to the base address for each section in the image.
5187 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5188 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5189 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5190 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5191 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5192 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5193 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5194 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5195 each image section.
5196
5197 @quotation Warning
5198 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5199 data you want to preserve.
5200 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5201 sections might be erased with no notice.
5202 @itemize
5203 @item
5204 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5205 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5206 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5207 @item
5208 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5209 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5210 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5211 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5212 @end itemize
5213 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5214 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5215 @end quotation
5216
5217 @end deffn
5218
5219 @section Other Flash commands
5220 @cindex flash protection
5221
5222 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5223 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5224 and display that status.
5225 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5226 @end deffn
5227
5228 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5229 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5230 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5231
5232 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5233 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5234 and possibly stale information.
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @anchor{flashprotect}
5238 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5239 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5240 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5241 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5242 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5243 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5244 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5245 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5246 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5247 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5248 @end deffn
5249
5250 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5251 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5252 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5253 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5254 @end deffn
5255
5256 @anchor{program}
5257 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5258 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5259 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5260 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5261 @end deffn
5262
5263 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5264 @section Flash Driver List
5265 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5266 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5267 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5268
5269 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5270 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5271 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5272
5273 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5274
5275 @itemize
5276 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5277 @end itemize
5278
5279 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5280 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5281 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5282 @example
5283 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5284 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5285 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5286 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5287 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5288 @end example
5289 @end deffn
5290
5291 @subsection External Flash
5292
5293 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5294 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5295 @cindex CFI
5296 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5297 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5298 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5299 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5300 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5301 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5302 configure a bus and its timings), or
5303 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5304 on the flash chip.
5305 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5306 speed up operation.
5307
5308 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5309
5310 @itemize
5311 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5312 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5313 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5314 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5315 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5316 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5317 @end itemize
5318
5319 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5320 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5321
5322 @example
5323 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5324 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5325 @end example
5326
5327 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5328 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5329 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5330
5331 @example
5332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5333 @end example
5334
5335 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5336 @end deffn
5337
5338 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5339 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5340 @cindex SPI
5341 @cindex jtagspi
5342 @cindex bscan_spi
5343 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5344 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5345 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5346 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5347 accessed through JTAG.
5348
5349 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5350 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5351 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5352 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5353 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5354 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5355
5356 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5357 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5358 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5359 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5360 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5361 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5362 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5363 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5364
5365 @itemize
5366 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5367 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5368 @var{USER1} instruction.
5369 @end itemize
5370
5371 @example
5372 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5373 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5375 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5376 @end example
5377 @end deffn
5378
5379 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5380 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5381 @cindex xcf
5382 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5383 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5384 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5385 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5386 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5387
5388 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5389 command accepts additional parameters:
5390 @itemize
5391 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5392 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5393 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5394 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5395 in master mode.
5396 @end itemize
5397 @example
5398 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5399 @end example
5400 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5401 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5402 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5403 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5404 dedicated sector.
5405 @end deffn
5406
5407 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5408 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5409 button.
5410 @example
5411 xcf configure 0
5412 @end example
5413 @end deffn
5414
5415 Additional driver notes:
5416 @itemize
5417 @item Only single revision supported.
5418 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5419 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5420 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5421 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5422 @end itemize
5423 @end deffn
5424
5425 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5426 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5427 @cindex SPIFI
5428 @cindex lpcspifi
5429 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5430 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5431 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5432
5433 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5434 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5435 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5436 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5437 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5438
5439 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5440 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5441 are configured by the driver.
5442
5443 @example
5444 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5445 @end example
5446
5447 @end deffn
5448
5449 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5450 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5451 @cindex SMI
5452 @cindex stmsmi
5453 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5454 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5455 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5456 SPI flash devices.
5457 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5458 flash devices can be connected.
5459
5460 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5461 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5462 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5463 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5464 the flash content.
5465
5466 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5467 to identify the memory bank.
5468 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5469 flash size, are detected automatically.
5470
5471 @example
5472 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5473 @end example
5474
5475 @end deffn
5476
5477 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5478 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5479 Microcontroller platform.
5480
5481 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5482 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5483
5484 @example
5485 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5486 @end example
5487
5488 @end deffn
5489
5490 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5491 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5492 @cindex ath79
5493 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5494 chip selects.
5495 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5496 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5497 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5498 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5499 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5500 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5501
5502 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5503 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5504 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5505 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5506 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5507 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5508 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5509 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5510 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5511 with the default CS0.
5512 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5513 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5514 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5515
5516 @example
5517 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5518
5519 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5520 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5521 # banks.
5522 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5523 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5524 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5525 @end example
5526
5527 @end deffn
5528
5529 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5530 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5531 @cindex fespi
5532
5533 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5534
5535 @example
5536 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5537 @end example
5538 @end deffn
5539
5540 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5541
5542 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5543 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5544 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5545 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5546 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5547 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5548
5549 @example
5550 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5551 @end example
5552 @end deffn
5553
5554 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5555 @cindex ambiqmicro
5556 @cindex apollo
5557 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5558 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5559 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5560 with the target using SWD.
5561
5562 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5563 the device class of the MCU.
5564 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5565 to set up the flash banks.
5566 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5567 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5568
5569 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5570 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5571 and the second bank starts after the first.
5572
5573 @example
5574 # Flash bank 0
5575 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5576 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5577 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5578 $_TARGETNAME
5579 @end example
5580
5581 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5582 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5583 are available to the user.
5584
5585 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5586
5587 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5588 Erase entire bank.
5589 @end deffn
5590 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5591 Erase device pages.
5592 @end deffn
5593 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5594 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5595 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5596 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5597 the flash.
5598 @end deffn
5599 @end deffn
5600
5601 @anchor{at91samd}
5602 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5603 @cindex at91samd
5604 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5605 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5606
5607 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5608
5609 The devices have one flash bank:
5610
5611 @example
5612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5613 @end example
5614
5615 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5616 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5617 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5618 processor to be halted.
5619 @end deffn
5620
5621 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5622 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5623 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5624 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5625 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5626 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5627
5628 @example
5629 at91samd set-security enable
5630 @end example
5631 @end deffn
5632
5633 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5634 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5635 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5636 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5637 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5638 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5639 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5640 in order to disable this feature.
5641
5642 @example
5643 at91samd eeprom
5644 at91samd eeprom 1024
5645 @end example
5646 @end deffn
5647
5648 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5649 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5650 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5651 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5652 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5653 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5654
5655 @example
5656 at91samd bootloader
5657 at91samd bootloader 16384
5658 @end example
5659 @end deffn
5660
5661 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5662 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5663 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5664 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5668 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5669 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5670 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5671 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5672 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5673 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5674 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5675
5676 @example
5677 # Read user row
5678 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5679 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5680 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5681 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5682 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5683 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5684 @end example
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @end deffn
5688
5689 @anchor{at91sam3}
5690 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5691 @cindex at91sam3
5692 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5693 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5694 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5695 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5696 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5697 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5698 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5699 chips are confirmed.}
5700
5701 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5702 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5703 the following fixed locations:
5704
5705 @example
5706 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5707 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5708 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5710 @end example
5711
5712 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5713 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5714 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5715
5716 @itemize
5717 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5718 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5719 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5720 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5721 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5722 @end itemize
5723
5724 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5725
5726 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5727 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5728 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5729 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5730 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5731 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5732 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5733
5734 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5735 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5736 @end deffn
5737
5738 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5739 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5740 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5741 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5742 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5743 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5744 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5745 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5746 @end deffn
5747
5748 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5749 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5750 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5751 @end deffn
5752 @end deffn
5753
5754 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5755 @cindex at91sam4
5756 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5757 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5758 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5759 @end deffn
5760
5761 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5762 @cindex at91sam4l
5763 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5764 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5765 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5766
5767 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5768 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5769 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5770 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5771 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5772 @end deffn
5773 @end deffn
5774
5775 @anchor{atsame5}
5776 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5777 @cindex atsame5
5778 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5779 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5780 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5781
5782 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5783 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5784 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5785
5786 @example
5787 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5788 @end example
5789
5790 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5791 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5792 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5793 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5794 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5795 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5796
5797 @example
5798 atsame5 bootloader
5799 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5800 @end example
5801 @end deffn
5802
5803 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5804 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5805 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5806 processor to be halted.
5807 @end deffn
5808
5809 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5810 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5811 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5812 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5816 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5817 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5818 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5819 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5820 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5821 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5822 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5823
5824 @example
5825 # Read
5826 >atsame5 userpage
5827 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5828 # Write
5829 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5830 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5831 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5832 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5833 @end example
5834 @end deffn
5835
5836 @end deffn
5837
5838 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5839 @cindex atsamv
5840 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5841 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5842 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5843 @end deffn
5844
5845 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5846 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5847 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5848 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5849 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5850
5851 @example
5852 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5853 @end example
5854
5855 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5856 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5857
5858 @itemize
5859 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5860 @item @var{banks}
5861 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5862 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5863 @item @var{pages_size}
5864 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5865 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5866 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5867 @end itemize
5868
5869 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5870 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5871 will be autoconfigured.
5872 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5873
5874 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5875 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5876 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5877 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5878 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5879
5880 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5881 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5882 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5883 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5884 are not truly general purpose).
5885 @quotation Note
5886 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5887 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5888 @end quotation
5889 @end deffn
5890 @end deffn
5891
5892 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5893 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5894 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5895 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5896 @end deffn
5897
5898 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5899 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5900 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5901 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5902
5903 @example
5904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5905 @end example
5906
5907 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5908 each single sector one by one.
5909
5910 @example
5911 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5912 @end example
5913
5914 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5915 @end deffn
5916
5917 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5918 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5919 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5920 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5921 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5922 starts at address 0.
5923
5924 @example
5925 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5926 @end example
5927 @end deffn
5928
5929 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5930 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5931 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5932 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5933 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5934 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5935 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5936 and programming the serial flash.
5937
5938 @example
5939 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5940 @end example
5941 @end deffn
5942
5943 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5944 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5945 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5946 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5947 autoconfigures itself.
5948 @example
5949 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5950 @end example
5951 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5952 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5953 this via the following command:
5954 @example
5955 efm32 debuglock num
5956 @end example
5957 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5958 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5959 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5960 supported.}
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5964 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5965 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5966 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5967 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5968 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5969
5970 @example
5971 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5972 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5973 @end example
5974
5975 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5976 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5980 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5981 is an uncommon operation.}
5982 @end deffn
5983 @end deffn
5984
5985 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5986 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5987 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5988 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5989 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5990 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5991 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5992
5993 @example
5994 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5995 @end example
5996 @end deffn
5997
5998 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5999 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6000 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6001 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6002 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6003 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6004 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6005 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6006 characters) ignored.
6007
6008 @example
6009 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6010 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6011 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6012 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6013 @end example
6014 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6015 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6019 @cindex kinetis
6020 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6021 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6022 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6023 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6024 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6025 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6026
6027 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6028 @itemize
6029 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6030 @end itemize
6031
6032 @example
6033 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6034 @end example
6035
6036 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6037 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6038 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6039 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6040 @end deffn
6041
6042 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6043 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6044 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6045 set by 'flash protect' command.
6046 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6047 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6048 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6049 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6050 with the rest of a flash image.
6051 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6052 @end deffn
6053
6054 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6055 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6056 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6057 @end deffn
6058
6059 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6060 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6061 and examine-fail event.
6062 @end deffn
6063
6064 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6065 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6066 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6067 @end deffn
6068
6069 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6070 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6071 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6072 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6073 command completes.
6074 @end deffn
6075
6076 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6077 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6078 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6079 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6080 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6081
6082 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6083 Program Partition command.
6084
6085 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6086 Reset the device after partition setting.
6087
6088 Show partition size:
6089 @example
6090 kinetis nvm_partition info
6091 @end example
6092
6093 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6094 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6095 @example
6096 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6097 @end example
6098
6099 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6100 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6101 @example
6102 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6103 @end example
6104 @end deffn
6105
6106 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6107 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6108 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6109 @end deffn
6110
6111 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6112 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6113 Command disables watchdog timer.
6114 @end deffn
6115 @end deffn
6116
6117 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6118 @cindex kinetis_ke
6119 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6120 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6121 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6122 autoconfigures itself.
6123 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6124
6125 @example
6126 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6127 @end example
6128
6129 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6130 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6131 @end deffn
6132
6133 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6134 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6135 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6136 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6137 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6138 @end deffn
6139
6140 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6141 Command disables watchdog timer.
6142 @end deffn
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6146 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6147 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6148 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6149 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6150
6151 @quotation Note
6152 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6153 driver:
6154 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6155 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6156 @end quotation
6157
6158 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6159 which must appear in the following order:
6160
6161 @itemize
6162 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6163 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6164 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6165 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6166 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6167 LPC43x[2357])
6168 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6169 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6170 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6171 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6172 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6173 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6174 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6175 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6176 at which the core is running
6177 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6178 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6179 @quotation Note
6180 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6181 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6182 However, if you do provide it,
6183 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6184 @end quotation
6185 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6186 ROM IAP entry point.
6187 @end itemize
6188
6189 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6190
6191 @example
6192 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6193 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6194 @end example
6195
6196 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6197 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6198 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6199 @end deffn
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6203 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6204 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6205 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6206 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6207 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6208
6209 @example
6210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6211 @end example
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6215 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6216 from NXP.
6217
6218 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6219 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6220 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6221 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6222 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6223 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6224 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6225 you start the PLL.
6226
6227 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6228
6229 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6230 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6231 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6232
6233 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6234 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6235 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6236 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6237 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6238 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6239 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6240
6241 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6242 @example
6243 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6244 @end example
6245
6246 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6247 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6248 @code{flash banks} command.
6249
6250 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6251 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6252 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6253 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6254 a known signature.
6255 Example:
6256 @example
6257 lpc2900 signature 0
6258 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6259 @end example
6260 @end deffn
6261
6262 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6263 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6264 saves it to a file in binary format.
6265 Example:
6266 @example
6267 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6268 @end example
6269 @end deffn
6270
6271 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6272 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6273 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6274 command:
6275
6276 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6277 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6278 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6279 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6280
6281 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6282 Example:
6283 @example
6284 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6285 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6286 @end example
6287 @end deffn
6288
6289 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6290 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6291 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6292 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6293 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6294 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6295 912 bytes.
6296 @quotation Attention
6297 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6298 @end quotation
6299 Example:
6300 @example
6301 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6302 @end example
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6306 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6307 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6308 after the next power cycle.
6309 @quotation Attention
6310 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6311 @end quotation
6312 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6313 Example:
6314 @example
6315 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6316 flash info 0
6317 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6318 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6319 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6320 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6321 @end example
6322 @end deffn
6323
6324 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6325 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6326 effective after the next power cycle.
6327 @quotation Attention
6328 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6329 @end quotation
6330 Examples:
6331 @example
6332 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6333 @end example
6334 @end deffn
6335 @end deffn
6336
6337 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6338 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6339 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6340 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6341
6342 @example
6343 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6344 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6345 @end example
6346
6347 @itemize @bullet
6348 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6349 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6350 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6351 @end itemize
6352
6353 Example usage:
6354 @example
6355 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6356 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6357 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6358 @} else @{
6359 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6360 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6361 @}
6362 @end example
6363 @end deffn
6364
6365 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6366 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6367 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6368 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6369 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6370 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6371
6372 @example
6373 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6374 @end example
6375
6376 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6377 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6378 only the main program flash.
6379
6380 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6381 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6382 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6383 @end deffn
6384
6385 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6386 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6387 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6388 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6389
6390 To erase and program the BSL:
6391 @example
6392 msp432 bsl unlock
6393 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6394 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6395 msp432 bsl lock
6396 @end example
6397 @end deffn
6398 @end deffn
6399
6400 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6401 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6402 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6403 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6404 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6405 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6406 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6407 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6408 also have division into regions: main and info.
6409 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6410 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6411
6412 @example
6413 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6414 @end example
6415
6416 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6417
6418 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6419 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6420 @end deffn
6421
6422 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6423 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6424 @end deffn
6425
6426 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6427 Erase all userflash including info region.
6428 @end deffn
6429
6430 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6431 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6432 @end deffn
6433
6434 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6435 Check sectors protect.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6439 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6443 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6447 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6451 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6452 @end deffn
6453
6454 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6455 Show information about flash driver.
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @end deffn
6459
6460 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6461 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6462 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6463 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6464 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6465
6466 @example
6467 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6468 @end example
6469
6470 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6471
6472 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6473 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6474 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6475 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6476 code.
6477 @end deffn
6478
6479 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6480 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6481 @end deffn
6482
6483 @end deffn
6484
6485 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6486 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6487 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6488
6489 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6490 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6491 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6492 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6493
6494 @example
6495 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6496 @end example
6497 @end deffn
6498
6499 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6500 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6501 and integrate flash memory.
6502
6503 @example
6504 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6505 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6506 @end example
6507
6508 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6509 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6510 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6511 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6512 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6513 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6514 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6515 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6516 @end deffn
6517 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6518 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6519 This will remove any Code Protection.
6520 @end deffn
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6524 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6525 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6526 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6527 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6528
6529 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6530 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6531
6532 @example
6533 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6534 @end example
6535
6536 psoc4-specific commands
6537 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6538 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6539
6540 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6541 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6542
6543 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6544 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6545 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6546
6547 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6548 @end deffn
6549
6550 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6551 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6552
6553 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6554 @end deffn
6555 @end deffn
6556
6557 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6558 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6559 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6560 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6561 apart from the base address.
6562
6563 @example
6564 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6565 @end example
6566
6567 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6568 @quotation Attention
6569 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6570 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6571 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6572 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6573 @end quotation
6574
6575 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6576
6577 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6578 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6579 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6580 @end deffn
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6584 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6585 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6586 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6587 apart from the base address.
6588
6589 @example
6590 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6591 @end example
6592 @end deffn
6593
6594 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6595 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6596 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6597 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6598
6599 @example
6600 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6601 @end example
6602
6603 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6604
6605 @itemize
6606 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6607 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6608 @end itemize
6609
6610 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6611
6612 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6613 @quotation Attention
6614 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6615 after successful write.
6616 @end quotation
6617 @end deffn
6618
6619 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6620 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6621 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6622 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6623
6624 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6625 @itemize @bullet
6626 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6627 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6628 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6629 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6630 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6631 row size: 512 bytes.
6632 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6633 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6634 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6635 operation will erase row automatically.
6636 @end itemize
6637
6638 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6639 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6640
6641 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6642
6643 @example
6644 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6645 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6646 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6647 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6648 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6649 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6650
6651 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6652 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6653 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6654 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6655 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6656 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6657 @end example
6658
6659 psoc6-specific commands
6660 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6661 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6662 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6663 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6664 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6665 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6669 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6670 by @command{flash banks}.
6671 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6672 @end deffn
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6676 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6677 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6678 and SWD interface.
6679 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6680 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6681
6682 @example
6683 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6684 @end example
6685
6686 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6687
6688 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6689 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6690 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6694 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6695 @end deffn
6696 @end deffn
6697
6698 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6699 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6700 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6701 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6702 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6703
6704 @example
6705 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6706 @end example
6707
6708 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6709 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6710 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6711 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6712 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6713 disabled.
6714
6715 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6716 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6717 @quotation Warning
6718 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6719 applied to all of them.
6720 @end quotation
6721 @end deffn
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6725 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6726 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6727 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6728 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6729
6730 @example
6731 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6732 @end example
6733
6734 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6735 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6736 the flash driver.
6737
6738 @example
6739 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6740 @end example
6741
6742 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6743 as per the following example.
6744 @example
6745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6746 @end example
6747
6748 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6749
6750 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6751 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6752 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6753 @end deffn
6754
6755 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6756 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6757 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6758 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6759 @end deffn
6760
6761 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6762 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6763 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6767 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6768 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6769 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6770 @end deffn
6771
6772 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6773 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6774 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6775 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6776 @end deffn
6777
6778 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6779 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6780 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6781 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6782 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6783 @end deffn
6784 @end deffn
6785
6786 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6787 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6788 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6789 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6790 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6791
6792 @example
6793 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6794 @end example
6795
6796 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6797 as per the following example.
6798 @example
6799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6800 @end example
6801
6802 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6803 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6804 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6805 @end deffn
6806
6807 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6808 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6809 the flash driver.
6810
6811 @example
6812 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6813 @end example
6814
6815 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6816
6817 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6818 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6819 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6820 @end deffn
6821
6822 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6823 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6824 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6828 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6829 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6830 @end deffn
6831
6832 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6833 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6834 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6838 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6839 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6840 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6841 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6842 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6846 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6847 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6848 @end deffn
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6852 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6853 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6854 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6855 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6856
6857 @example
6858 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6859 @end example
6860
6861 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6862 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6863 the flash driver.
6864
6865 @example
6866 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6867 @end example
6868
6869 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6870
6871 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6872 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6873 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6877 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6878 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6882 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6883 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6884 @end deffn
6885
6886 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6887 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6888 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6889 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6890 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6891
6892 Example usage:
6893 @example
6894 # read OPTSR_CUR
6895 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6896 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6897 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6898 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6899 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6900 @end example
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6904 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6905 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6906 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6907 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6908 will be touched).
6909
6910 Example usage:
6911 @example
6912 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6913 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6914 @end example
6915 @end deffn
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6919 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6920 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6921 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6922 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6923
6924 @example
6925 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6926 @end example
6927
6928 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6929 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6930 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6931 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6932 second bank.
6933
6934 @example
6935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6936 @end example
6937
6938 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6939
6940 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6941 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6942 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6943 @end deffn
6944
6945 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6946 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6951 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6952 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6953 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6954 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6955 @end deffn
6956 @end deffn
6957
6958 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6959 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6960 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6961 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6962 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
6963 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6964 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6965
6966 @example
6967 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6968 @end example
6969
6970 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6971 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6972 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
6973 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
6974
6975 @example
6976 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6977 @end example
6978
6979 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6980
6981 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6982 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6983 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6984 @end deffn
6985
6986 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6987 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6988 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6992 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6993 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6997 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6998 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6999 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7000
7001 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7002 @example
7003 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7004 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7005 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7006 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7007 @end example
7008
7009 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7010 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7011 @end deffn
7012
7013 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7014 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7015 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7016 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7017 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7018
7019 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7020 @example
7021 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7022 @end example
7023
7024 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7025 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7026 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7027 @end deffn
7028
7029 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7030 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7031 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7032 @end deffn
7033 @end deffn
7034
7035 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7036 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7037 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7038 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7039 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7040
7041 @example
7042 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7043 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7044 @end example
7045
7046 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7047 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7048 for the specified flash bank.
7049 @end deffn
7050 @end deffn
7051
7052 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7053 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7054 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7055 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7056 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7057
7058 @example
7059 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7060 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7061 @end example
7062
7063 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7064 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7065 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7066
7067 @itemize @bullet
7068 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7069 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7070 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7071 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7072 @end itemize
7073 @end deffn
7074
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7078 @cindex str9xpec
7079
7080 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7081 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7082 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7083 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7084
7085 Here is some background info to help
7086 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7087 the str9:
7088 @enumerate
7089 @item
7090 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7091 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7092 @item
7093 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7094 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7095 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7096 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7097 @end enumerate
7098
7099 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7100 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7101 configured for flash bank 0.
7102 @example
7103 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7104 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7105 adapter assert srst
7106 # turn off target polling
7107 poll off
7108 # disable str9 core
7109 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7110 # read option bytes
7111 str9xpec options_read 0
7112 # re-enable str9 core
7113 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7114 poll on
7115 reset halt
7116 @end example
7117 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7118 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7119 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7120 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7121
7122 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7123
7124 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7125 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7129 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7130 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7131 @end deffn
7132
7133 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7134 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7135 erase the device.
7136 @end deffn
7137
7138 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7139 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7140 @end deffn
7141
7142 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7143 Configure str9 boot bank.
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7147 Configure str9 lvd source.
7148 @end deffn
7149
7150 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7151 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7152 @end deffn
7153
7154 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7155 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7159 Read str9 option bytes.
7160 @end deffn
7161
7162 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7163 Write str9 option bytes.
7164 @end deffn
7165
7166 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7167 unlock str9 device.
7168 @end deffn
7169
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7173 @cindex swm050
7174 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7175
7176 @example
7177 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7178 @end example
7179
7180 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7181
7182 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7183 Erases the entire flash bank.
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188
7189 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7190 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7191 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7192 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7193
7194 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7195
7196 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7197 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7201 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7205 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7206 the flash clock.
7207 @end deffn
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7211 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7212 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7213 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7214 correct bank config.
7215
7216 @example
7217 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7218 @end example
7219 @end deffn
7220
7221 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7222 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7223 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7227 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7228 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7229
7230 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7231
7232 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7233 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7234 @end deffn
7235
7236 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7237 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7238 @end deffn
7239
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @section NAND Flash Commands
7243 @cindex NAND
7244
7245 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7246 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7247 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7248
7249 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7250 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7251 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7252 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7253 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7254 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7255
7256 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7257 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7258 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7259 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7260 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7261 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7262 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7263 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7264 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7265 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7266
7267 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7268 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7269 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7270 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7271 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7272 every 512 bytes of data.
7273
7274 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7275 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7276 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7277 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7278 ECC mode is used.
7279
7280 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7281 @enumerate
7282 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7283 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7284 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7285 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7286 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7287 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7288 to access that device.
7289 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7290 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7291 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7292 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7293 de-brick a board.
7294 @end enumerate
7295
7296 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7297 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7298 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7299 are only 32 bits wide.
7300 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7301 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7302 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7303 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7304
7305 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7306 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7307 @cindex NAND configuration
7308
7309 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7310 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7311 OpenOCD has initialized.
7312
7313 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7314 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7315 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7316 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7317 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7318 they were a single (larger) device.
7319 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7320 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7321
7322 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7323 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7324 configuration files, not interactively.
7325
7326 @itemize @bullet
7327 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7328 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7329 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7330 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7331 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7332 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7333 commands to the NAND controller.
7334 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7335 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7336 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7337 for more information.
7338 @end itemize
7339 @end deffn
7340
7341 @deffn Command {nand list}
7342 Prints a summary of each device declared
7343 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7344 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7345 @example
7346 > nand list
7347 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7348 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7349 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7350 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7351 >
7352 @end example
7353 @end deffn
7354
7355 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7356 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7357 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7358 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7359 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7360 it with most other NAND commands.
7361 @end deffn
7362
7363 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7364
7365 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7366 @cindex NAND reading
7367 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7368 starting at the specified offset.
7369 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7370
7371 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7372 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7373
7374 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7375 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7376 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7377
7378 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7379 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7380 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7381 method which handled that error correction.
7382
7383 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7384 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7385 @itemize @bullet
7386 @item no oob_* parameter
7387 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7388 @item @code{oob_raw}
7389 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7390 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7391 spare areas associated with each data page.
7392 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7393 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7394 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7395 @item @code{oob_only}
7396 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7397 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7398 spare areas associated with each data page.
7399 @end itemize
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7403 @cindex NAND erasing
7404 @cindex NAND programming
7405 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7406 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7407 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7408 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7409 If those parameters are not specified,
7410 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7411 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7412
7413 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7414 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7415 block marker.
7416 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7417 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7418 @end deffn
7419
7420 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7421 @cindex NAND writing
7422 @cindex NAND programming
7423 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7424 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7425 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7426 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7427
7428 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7429 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7430
7431 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7432 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7433 past the end of the device.
7434 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7435 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7436 if that's being written.)
7437
7438 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7439 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7440 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7441
7442 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7443 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7444 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7445 @itemize @bullet
7446 @item no oob_* parameter
7447 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7448 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7449 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7450 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7451 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7452 @item @code{oob_only}
7453 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7454 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7455 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7456 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7457 @item @code{oob_raw}
7458 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7459 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7460 un-altered OOB.
7461 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7462 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7463 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7464 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7465 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7466 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7467 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7468 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7469 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7470 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7471 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7472 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7473 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7474 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7475 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7476 @end itemize
7477 @end deffn
7478
7479 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7480 @cindex NAND verification
7481 @cindex NAND programming
7482 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7483 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7484 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7485
7486 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7487 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7488
7489 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7490 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7491 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7492 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7493 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7494
7495 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7496 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7497 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7498
7499 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7500 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7501 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7502 be removed in a future release.
7503 @end deffn
7504
7505 @subsection Other NAND commands
7506 @cindex NAND other commands
7507
7508 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7509 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7510 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7511 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7512 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7513 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7514 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7515 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7516
7517 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7518 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7519 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7523 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7524 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7525 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7526 status for each block.
7527 @end deffn
7528
7529 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7530 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7531 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7532
7533 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7534 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7535 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7536 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7537 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7538
7539 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7540 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7541 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7542 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7543 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7544 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7545 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7546 @end deffn
7547
7548 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7549 @subsection NAND Driver List
7550 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7551 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7552 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7553
7554 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7555 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7556 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7557 address of the ECC controller.
7558 @example
7559 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7560 @end example
7561 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7562 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7563 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7564 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7565 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7566 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7567 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7568 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7569 @end deffn
7570 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7571 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7572 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7573 @end deffn
7574
7575 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7576 properly configured for input or output.
7577 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7578 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7579 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7580 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7581 @end deffn
7582 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7583 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7584 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7585 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7586 @end deffn
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7590 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7591 chips from Texas Instruments.
7592 It takes three extra parameters:
7593 address of the NAND chip;
7594 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7595 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7596 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7597 @example
7598 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7599 @end example
7600 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7601 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7602 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7603 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7604 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7608 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7609 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7610 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7611 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7612 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7613 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7617 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7618 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7619 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7620 @end deffn
7621 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7622
7623 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7624 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7625 should work for this chip as well.
7626 @end deffn
7627
7628 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7629 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7630 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7631 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7632 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7633 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7634 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7635 @example
7636 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7637 @end example
7638 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7639 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7640 without parameter query status.
7641 @end deffn
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7645 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7646 parameter: the address of the controller.
7647 @example
7648 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7649 @end example
7650 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7651 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7652 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7653 change any behavior.
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7657 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7658 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7659 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7660 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7661 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7662 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7663 specialized commands.
7664 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7665 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7666 change any behavior.
7667 @end deffn
7668
7669 @node Flash Programming
7670 @chapter Flash Programming
7671
7672 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7673 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7674 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7675
7676 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7677 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7678
7679 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7680 @enumerate
7681 @item 'init' is executed.
7682 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7683 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7684 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7685 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7686 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7687 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7688 @end enumerate
7689
7690 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7691
7692 @example
7693 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7694 # are optional parameters
7695 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7696 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7697
7698 # binary files need the flash address passing
7699 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7700 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7701 @end example
7702
7703 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7704 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7705 @cindex PLD
7706 @cindex FPGA
7707
7708 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7709 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7710 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7711 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7712 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7713 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7714 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7715
7716 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7717
7718 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7719 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7720 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7721
7722 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7723 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7724
7725 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7726 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7727 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7728 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7729 behavior.
7730 @end deffn
7731
7732 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7733 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7734 @end deffn
7735
7736 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7737 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7738 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7739 @end deffn
7740
7741 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7742
7743 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7744 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7745 that particular type of PLD.
7746
7747 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7748 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7749 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7750
7751 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7752 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7753 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7754
7755 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7756 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7757 for FPGA @var{num}.
7758 @end deffn
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @node General Commands
7762 @chapter General Commands
7763 @cindex commands
7764
7765 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7766 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7767 commands are documented elsewhere.
7768
7769 Intent:
7770 @itemize @bullet
7771 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7772 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7773 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7774 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7775
7776 @item @b{From the human}
7777 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7778 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7779
7780 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7781 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7782 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7783
7784 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7785 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7786 port is 5555.
7787 @end itemize
7788
7789
7790 @section Server Commands
7791
7792 @deffn {Command} exit
7793 Exits the current telnet session.
7794 @end deffn
7795
7796 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7797 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7798 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7799 Not every command provides helptext.
7800
7801 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7802 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7803 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7804 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7808 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7809 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7810 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7811 Useful in connection with script files
7812 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7816 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7817 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7818 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7819
7820 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7821 @example
7822 # redefine shutdown
7823 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7824 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7825 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7826 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7827 original_shutdown
7828 @}
7829 @end example
7830 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7831 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7832 @end deffn
7833
7834 @anchor{debuglevel}
7835 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7836 @cindex message level
7837 Display debug level.
7838 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7839 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7840 Level 0 is error messages only;
7841 level 1 adds warnings;
7842 level 2 adds informational messages;
7843 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7844 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7845 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7846 the command line along with the location of that log
7847 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7848 @xref{Running}.
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7852 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7853 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7854 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7855 @example
7856 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7857 @end example
7858 @end deffn
7859
7860 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7861 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7862 the default log output channel is stderr.
7863 @end deffn
7864
7865 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7866 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7867 @end deffn
7868
7869 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7870 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7871 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7872 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7873 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7874 @end deffn
7875
7876 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7877 @section Target State handling
7878 @cindex reset
7879 @cindex halt
7880 @cindex target initialization
7881
7882 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7883 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7884 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7885 a current target which is used to perform the
7886 various operations. The current target may be changed
7887 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7888 target which should become current.
7889
7890 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7891 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7892 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7893 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7894 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7895
7896 @emph{With no arguments}:
7897 list all available registers for the current target,
7898 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7899 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7900 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7901 are flagged as such.
7902
7903 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7904 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7905 bypassing any internal cache.
7906
7907 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7908 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7909 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7910 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7911 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7912 relevant module will flush such values.
7913
7914 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7915 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7916
7917 @example
7918 > reg
7919 ===== ARM registers
7920 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7921 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7922 (2) r2 (/32)
7923 ...
7924 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7925 >
7926 @end example
7927 @end deffn
7928
7929 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7930 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7931 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7932 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7933 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7934 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7935 (and enter debug mode).
7936 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7937
7938 @quotation Warning
7939 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7940 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7941 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7942 power mode by gating the core clock;
7943 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7944
7945 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7946 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7947 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7948 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7949 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7950 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7951
7952 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7953 work with a JTAG debugger.
7954 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7955 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7956 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7957 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7958 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7959 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7960 @end quotation
7961
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @deffn Command resume [address]
7965 Resume the target at its current code position,
7966 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7967 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @deffn Command step [address]
7971 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7972 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @anchor{resetcommand}
7976 @deffn Command reset
7977 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7978 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7979 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7980 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7981 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7982 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7983
7984 The optional parameter specifies what should
7985 happen after the reset.
7986 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7987 The other options will not work on all systems.
7988 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7989
7990 @itemize @minus
7991 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7992 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7993 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7994 @end itemize
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7998 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7999 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8000 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8001 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8002 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8003 state.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8007 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8008 Set values of reset signals.
8009 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8010 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8011 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8012 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8013
8014 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8015 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8016 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8017 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8018 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8019 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8020 the signal will not be modified.
8021
8022 @quotation Note
8023 TRST is specially handled.
8024 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8025 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8026 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8027 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8028 instead of the TRST signal.
8029 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8030 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8031 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8032 with handlers for that event.
8033 @end quotation
8034 @end deffn
8035
8036 @section I/O Utilities
8037
8038 These commands are available when
8039 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8040 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8041 notably the ZY1000.
8042 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8043
8044 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8045
8046 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8047 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8048 the text file @file{filename}.
8049 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8050 The last string is followed by a newline.
8051 @end deffn
8052
8053 @deffn Command cat filename
8054 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8055 @end deffn
8056
8057 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8058 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8059 into @file{dest_filename}.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 @deffn Command ip
8063 @emph{No description provided.}
8064 @end deffn
8065
8066 @deffn Command ls
8067 @emph{No description provided.}
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn Command mac
8071 @emph{No description provided.}
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn Command meminfo
8075 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8076 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8077 @end deffn
8078
8079 @deffn Command peek
8080 @emph{No description provided.}
8081 @end deffn
8082
8083 @deffn Command poke
8084 @emph{No description provided.}
8085 @end deffn
8086
8087 @deffn Command rm filename
8088 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8089 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8090 @end deffn
8091
8092 @deffn Command trunc filename
8093 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8094 @end deffn
8095
8096 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8097 @section Memory access commands
8098 @cindex memory access
8099
8100 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8101 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8102 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8103 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8104
8105 @enumerate
8106 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8107 to change the current target.
8108 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8109 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8110 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8111 @end enumerate
8112
8113 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8114 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8115 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8116 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8117 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8118 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8119 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8120 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8121 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8122 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8123 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8124 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8125 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8126 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8127 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8128 @end deffn
8129
8130 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8131 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8132 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8133 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8134 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8135 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8136 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8137 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8138 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8139 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8140 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8141 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8142 @end deffn
8143
8144 @anchor{imageaccess}
8145 @section Image loading commands
8146 @cindex image loading
8147 @cindex image dumping
8148
8149 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8150 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8151 binary file named @var{filename}.
8152 @end deffn
8153
8154 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8155 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8156 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8157 @end deffn
8158
8159 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8160 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8161 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8162 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8163 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8164 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8165 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8166 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8167 separately.
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8171 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8172 The file format may optionally be specified
8173 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8174 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8175 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8176 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8177 @example
8178 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8179 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8180 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8181 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8182 $address $length
8183 @}
8184 @end example
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8188 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8189 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8190 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8191 The file format may optionally be specified
8192 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8193 @end deffn
8194
8195 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8196 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8197 The file format may optionally be specified
8198 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8199 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8200 @end deffn
8201
8202 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8203 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8204 The file format may optionally be specified
8205 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8206 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8207 @end deffn
8208
8209
8210 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8211 @cindex breakpoint
8212 @cindex watchpoint
8213
8214 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8215 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8216 watchpoints.
8217 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8218
8219 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8220 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8221 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8222 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8223 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8224 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8225
8226 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8227 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8228 @end deffn
8229
8230 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8231 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8232 @end deffn
8233
8234 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8235 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8236 @end deffn
8237
8238 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8239 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8240 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8241 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8242 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8243 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8244 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8245 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8246 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8247 @end deffn
8248
8249 @section Misc Commands
8250
8251 @cindex profiling
8252 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8253 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8254 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8255 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8256 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8257 limit the address range.
8258 @end deffn
8259
8260 @deffn Command {version}
8261 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8262 @end deffn
8263
8264 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8265 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8266 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8267 @end deffn
8268
8269 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8270 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8271 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8272 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8273
8274 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8275 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8276 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8277 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8278
8279 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8280 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8281 @cindex tracing
8282 @cindex ETM
8283 @cindex ETB
8284
8285 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8286 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8287 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8288
8289 @itemize
8290 @item
8291 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8292 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8293 supports such an interface.
8294 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8295 and trace port support.)
8296 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8297 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8298 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8299 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8300 in the board-specific configuration file.
8301 @item
8302 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8303 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8304 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8305 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8306 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8307 @end itemize
8308
8309 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8310
8311 @quotation Issues
8312 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8313 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8314
8315 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8316 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8317 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8318 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8319 dummy trace port driver}.
8320
8321 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8322 as well as tracing only during specific states
8323 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8324
8325 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8326 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8327 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8328 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8329 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8330
8331 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8332 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8333 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8334 this original style of JTAG access.
8335 @end quotation
8336
8337 @subsection ETM Configuration
8338 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8339
8340 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8341 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8342 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8343
8344 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8345 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8346 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8347 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8348 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8349 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8350 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8351 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8352 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8353
8354 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8355 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8356 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8357
8358 @quotation Warning
8359 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8360 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8361 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8362 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8363 @end quotation
8364
8365 @quotation Note
8366 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8367 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8368 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8369 what CPU activities are traced.
8370 @end quotation
8371 @end deffn
8372
8373 @deffn Command {etm info}
8374 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8375 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8376 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8377 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8378 @end deffn
8379
8380 @deffn Command {etm status}
8381 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8382 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8383 Did trace data overflow?
8384 Was it triggered?
8385 @end deffn
8386
8387 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8388 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8389 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8390 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8391 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8392
8393 @itemize
8394 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8395 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8396 The value is one of
8397 @option{none} (save nothing),
8398 @option{data} (save data),
8399 @option{address} (save addresses),
8400 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8401 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8402 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8403 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8404 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8405 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8406 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8407 trace stream without an image of the code.
8408 @end itemize
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8412 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8413 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8414 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8415 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8416
8417 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8418 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8419 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8420 @end deffn
8421
8422 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8423
8424 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8425 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8426 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8427
8428 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8429 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8430 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8431 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8432 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8433 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8434 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8435
8436 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8437
8438 @itemize
8439 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8440 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8441 for instruction access within that function's body.
8442 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8443 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8444 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8445 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8446 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8447 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8448 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8449 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8450 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8451 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8452 @item @emph{... more}
8453 @end itemize
8454
8455 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8456 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8457
8458 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8459 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8460 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8464 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8465 @end deffn
8466
8467 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8468 Opens an image file.
8469 @end deffn
8470
8471 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8472 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn Command {etm start}
8476 Starts trace data collection.
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8480 Stops trace data collection.
8481 @end deffn
8482
8483 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8484 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8485
8486 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8487
8488 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8489 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8490 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8491 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8492 any trace data collection.}
8493 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8494 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8495 @end deffn
8496 @end deffn
8497
8498 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8499 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8500 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8501 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8502 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8503 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8504 @end deffn
8505 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8506 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8507 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8508 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8509 trace trigger becomes active.
8510
8511 @itemize
8512 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8513 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8514 afterwards.
8515 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8516 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8517 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8518 what caused that event to happen.
8519 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8520 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8521 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8522 how the event caused trouble.
8523 @end itemize
8524 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8525 @end deffn
8526
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8530 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8531 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8532 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8533 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8534
8535 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8536 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8537
8538 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8539 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8540 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8541 @end deffn
8542
8543 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8544 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8545 @end deffn
8546
8547 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8548 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8549 @end deffn
8550 @end deffn
8551
8552 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8553 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8554 @cindex CTI
8555
8556 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8557 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8558 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8559 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8560 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8561 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8562
8563 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8564 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8565 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8566 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8567 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8568 including additional configuration.
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8572 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8576 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8577 @end deffn
8578
8579 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8580 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8584 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8588 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8589 @end deffn
8590
8591 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8592 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8593 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8594 @end deffn
8595
8596 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8597 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8598 of the CTI.
8599 @end deffn
8600
8601 @deffn Command {cti names}
8602 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8603 useful in TCL scripting.
8604 @end deffn
8605
8606 @section Generic ARM
8607 @cindex ARM
8608
8609 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8610 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8611 commands that may be available.
8612
8613 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8614 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8615 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8616 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8617 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8618 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8622 @cindex disassemble
8623 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8624 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8625 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8626 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8627 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8628 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8629 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8630
8631 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8632 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8633 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8634 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8635 with a handful of exceptions.
8636 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8637 @end deffn
8638
8639 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8640 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8641 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8642 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8643 and using the MCR instruction.
8644 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8645 an ARM register.)
8646 @end deffn
8647
8648 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8649 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8650 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8651 and the MRC instruction.
8652 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8653 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8654 an ARM register.)
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8658 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8659 core mode if necessary.
8660 @end deffn
8661
8662 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8663 @cindex ARM semihosting
8664 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8665
8666 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8667 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8668 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8669 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8670 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8671 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8672 @end deffn
8673
8674 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8675 @cindex ARM semihosting
8676 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8677
8678 @example
8679 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8680 @end example
8681
8682 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8683 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8684 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8685 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8686 @end deffn
8687
8688 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8689 @cindex ARM semihosting
8690 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8691 status.
8692
8693 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8694 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8695 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8696 debugger.
8697 @end deffn
8698
8699 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8700 @cindex ARM semihosting
8701 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8702
8703 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8704 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8705 the value returned by the target.
8706
8707 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8708 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8709 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8710 encountering a break.
8711
8712 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8713 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8714 to the debugger.
8715 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8716 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8717 request or equivalent").
8718
8719 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8720 this option (default: disabled).
8721 @end deffn
8722
8723 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8724 @cindex ARMv4
8725 @cindex ARMv5
8726
8727 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8728 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8729 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8730 variant.
8731
8732 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8733 @cindex ARM7
8734 @cindex ARM9
8735
8736 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8737 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8738 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8739 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8740
8741 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8742 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8743 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8744 instead of breakpoints.
8745 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8746
8747 This should be
8748 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8749 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8750 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8751 @end deffn
8752
8753 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8754 @cindex DCC
8755 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8756 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8757 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8758
8759 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8760 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8761 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8762 @end deffn
8763
8764 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8765 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8766 that don't check completion of the operation.
8767 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8768
8769 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8770 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8771 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8772 @end deffn
8773
8774 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8775 @cindex ARM720T
8776
8777 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8778 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8779 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8780 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8781
8782 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8783 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8784 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8785
8786 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8787 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8788 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8789 @end deffn
8790
8791 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8792 @cindex ARM9
8793
8794 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8795 integer processors.
8796 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8797
8798 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8799 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8800 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8801 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8802
8803 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8804 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8805 @cindex vector_catch
8806 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8807 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8808 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8809 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8810 to those hardware vectors.
8811
8812 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8813 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8814 vector catch hardware to intercept
8815 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8816 @option{none} of them,
8817 or a list with one or more of the following:
8818 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8819 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8820 @end deffn
8821
8822 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8823 @cindex ARM920T
8824
8825 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8826 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8827 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8828 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8829 and ARM9 commands.
8830
8831 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8832 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8833 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8834 @end deffn
8835
8836 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8837 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8838 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8839 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8840 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8841 (Not all registers can be written.)
8842 @end deffn
8843
8844 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8845 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8846 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8847
8848 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8849 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8850 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8851 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8852 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8853 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8854 @end deffn
8855
8856 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8857 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8858 @end deffn
8859
8860 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8861 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8862 @end deffn
8863
8864 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8865 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8866
8867 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8868 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8869 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8870 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8871 and ARM9 commands.
8872
8873 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8874 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8875
8876 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8877 Print information about the caches found.
8878 @end deffn
8879
8880 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8881 @cindex ARM966E
8882
8883 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8884 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8885 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8886 and ARM9 commands.
8887
8888 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8889 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8890 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8891 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8892 ARM966E-S TRM.
8893 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8894 as required for BIST support.
8895 @end deffn
8896
8897 @subsection XScale specific commands
8898 @cindex XScale
8899
8900 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8901
8902 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8903 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8904 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8905 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8906 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8907 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8908 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8909
8910 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8911 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8912 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8913 the mini-IC.
8914
8915 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8916 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8917 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8918 code layout in memory:
8919 @example
8920 _vectors:
8921 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8922 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8923 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8924 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8925 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8926 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8927 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8928 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8929 .org 0x100
8930 .long real_reset_vector
8931 .long real_ui_handler
8932 .long real_swi_handler
8933 .long real_pf_abort
8934 .long real_data_abort
8935 .long 0 /* unused */
8936 .long real_irq_handler
8937 .long real_fiq_handler
8938 @end example
8939
8940 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8941 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8942 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8943 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8944 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8945 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8946 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8947 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8948 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8949 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8950 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8951 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8952 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8953 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8954 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8955 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8956 software.
8957
8958 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8959 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8960 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8961 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8962
8963 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8964 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8965 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8966 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8967 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8968 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8969 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8970 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8971 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8972
8973 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8974 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8975
8976 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8977 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8978 @end deffn
8979
8980 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8981 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8982 @end deffn
8983
8984 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8985 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8986 @end deffn
8987
8988 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8989 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8990 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8991 @end deffn
8992
8993 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8994 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8995 @end deffn
8996
8997 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8998 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9002 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9006 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9007 @end deffn
9008
9009 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9010 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9011 @end deffn
9012
9013 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9014 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9015 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9016 and modifying how it is emptied.
9017 @end deffn
9018
9019 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9020 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9021 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9022 The image @var{type} may be one of
9023 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9024 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9025 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9026 @end deffn
9027
9028 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9029 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9030 @cindex vector_catch
9031 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9032 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9033
9034 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9035 @example
9036 0x01 Trap Reset
9037 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9038 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9039 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9040 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9041 0x20 reserved
9042 0x40 Trap IRQ
9043 0x80 Trap FIQ
9044 @end example
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9048 @cindex vector_table
9049
9050 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9051 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9052 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9053 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9054 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9055
9056 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9057
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9061 @cindex ARMv6
9062
9063 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9064 @cindex ARM11
9065
9066 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9067 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9068 which is enabled by default.
9069 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9070 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9071 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9072 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9073 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9074 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9078 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9079 which is enabled by default.
9080 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9081 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9082 @end deffn
9083
9084 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9085 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9086 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9087 they are disabled by default.
9088 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9092 @cindex vector_catch
9093 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9094 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9095 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9096
9097 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9098 for certain hardware events.
9099 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9100 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9101 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9102 @end deffn
9103
9104 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9105 @cindex ARMv7
9106 @cindex ARMv8
9107
9108 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9109 @cindex Cortex-A
9110
9111 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9112 display information about target caches
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9116 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9117 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9118 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9119 Defaults to 'off'.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9123 Initialize core debug
9124 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9125 @end deffn
9126
9127 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9128 Display/set the current SMP mode
9129 @end deffn
9130
9131 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9132 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9133 @end deffn
9134
9135 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9136 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9140 configure l2x cache
9141 @end deffn
9142
9143 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9144 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9145 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9146 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9147 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9148 @end deffn
9149
9150 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9151 @cindex Cortex-R
9152
9153 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9154 Initialize core debug
9155 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9156 @end deffn
9157
9158 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9159 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162
9163 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9164 @cindex tracing
9165 @cindex SWO
9166 @cindex SWV
9167 @cindex TPIU
9168 @cindex ITM
9169 @cindex ETM
9170
9171 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9172 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9173 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9174
9175 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9176 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9177 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9178 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9179
9180 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9181 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9182 debugger adapter features.
9183
9184 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9185 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9186
9187 Command options:
9188 @itemize @minus
9189 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9190 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9191 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9192 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9193 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9194 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9195 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9196 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9197 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9198 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9199 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9200 coding;
9201 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9202 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9203 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9204 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9205 data is to be output via SWO;
9206 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9207 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9208 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9209 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9210 rate automatically.
9211 @end itemize
9212
9213 Example usage:
9214 @enumerate
9215 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9216 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9217 enough to:
9218 @example
9219 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9220 ...
9221 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9222 ...
9223 @end example
9224 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9225 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9226 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9227 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9228 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9229 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9230 @example
9231 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9232 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9233 @end example
9234 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9235 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9236 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9237 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9238 @example
9239 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9240 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9241 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9242 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9243 @end example
9244 @end enumerate
9245 @end deffn
9246
9247 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9248 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9249 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9250 @end deffn
9251
9252 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9253 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9254 @end deffn
9255
9256 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9257 @cindex Cortex-M
9258
9259 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9260 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9261
9262 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9263 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9264 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9265 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9266 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9267 the step command leaves with the core running.
9268
9269 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9270 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9271 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9272 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9273
9274 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9275 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9276 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9277 does.
9278
9279 Default is @option{auto}.
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9283 @cindex vector_catch
9284 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9285 for certain hardware events.
9286
9287 Parameters request interception of
9288 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9289 @option{none} of them,
9290 or one or more of the following:
9291 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9292 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9293 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9294 @option{irq_err},
9295 @option{state_err},
9296 @option{chk_err}, or
9297 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9298 @option{reset}.
9299 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9300 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9301 are mapped to HardFault.
9302 UsageFault checks for
9303 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9304 must also be explicitly enabled.
9305
9306 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9307 @end deffn
9308
9309 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9310 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9311 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9312
9313 @itemize @minus
9314 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9315 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9316 @end itemize
9317
9318 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9319 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9320 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9321 to manually reset the peripherals.
9322 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9323
9324 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9325 instead.
9326 @end deffn
9327
9328 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9329 @cindex ARMv8-A
9330 @cindex aarch64
9331
9332 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9333 Display information about target caches
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9337 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9338 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9339 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9340 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9341 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9342 @end deffn
9343
9344 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9345 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9346 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9347 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9348 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9349 @end deffn
9350
9351 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9352 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9353 @option{on}.
9354 @end deffn
9355
9356 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9357 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9358 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9359 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9360 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9361 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9362 @end deffn
9363
9364 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9365
9366 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9367 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9368
9369 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9370
9371 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9372 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9373 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9374 @end deffn
9375
9376 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9377 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9378 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9379 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9380 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9381 @end deffn
9382
9383 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9384
9385 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9386 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9387 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9388 @end deffn
9389
9390 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9391
9392 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9393 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9394 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9395 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9396 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9397 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9398 can be collected.
9399
9400 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9401 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9402 tooling.
9403
9404 @quotation Issues
9405 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9406 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9407 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9408 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9409
9410 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9411 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9412 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9413 software operation on the CPU.
9414 @end quotation
9415
9416 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9417 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9418 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9419 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9423 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9424 @end deffn
9425
9426 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9427 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9428 control is disabled.
9429 @end deffn
9430
9431 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9432 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9433 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9434 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9435
9436 Supported trace formats:
9437 @itemize
9438 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9439 timing to be determined.
9440 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9441 addresses.
9442 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9443 @end itemize
9444 @end deffn
9445
9446 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9447 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9448 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9449 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9450
9451 Supported conditions:
9452 @itemize
9453 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9454 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9455 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9456 instruction matches start data and mask.
9457 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9458 instruction matches start data and mask.
9459 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9460 data and mask.
9461 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9462 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9463 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9464 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9465 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9466 @end itemize
9467 @end deffn
9468
9469 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9470 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9471 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9472 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9473
9474 Supported conditions:
9475 @itemize
9476 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9477 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9478 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9479 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9480 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9481 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9482 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9483 data and mask.
9484 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9485 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9486 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9487 @end itemize
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9491 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9492
9493 Supported triggers:
9494 @itemize
9495 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9496 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9497 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9498 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9499 collection.
9500 @end itemize
9501 @end deffn
9502
9503 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9504
9505 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9506 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9507 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9508 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9509 @end deffn
9510
9511 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9512 Display trace configuration.
9513 @end deffn
9514
9515 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9516 Display trace collection status.
9517 @end deffn
9518
9519 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9520 Start manual trace collection.
9521 @end deffn
9522
9523 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9524 Stop manual trace collection.
9525 @end deffn
9526
9527 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9528 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9529 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9530 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9531 @option{size} options using DMA.
9532 @end deffn
9533
9534 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9535 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9536 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9537 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9538 @option{size} options using DMA.
9539 @end deffn
9540
9541 @section Intel Architecture
9542
9543 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9544 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9545 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9546 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9547 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9548 @itemize
9549 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9550 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9551 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9552 @end itemize
9553
9554 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9555 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9556 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9557
9558 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9559 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9560 @end deffn
9561
9562 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9563 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9564 @end deffn
9565
9566 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9567 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9568 @end deffn
9569
9570 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9571 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9572 @end deffn
9573
9574 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9575 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9576 @end deffn
9577
9578 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9579 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9580 @end deffn
9581
9582 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9583
9584 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9585 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9586
9587 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9588 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9589 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9590 @end deffn
9591 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9592 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9593
9594 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9595
9596 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9597 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9598 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9599 @end deffn
9600
9601 @subsection Registers commands
9602 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9603 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9604 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9605
9606 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9607
9608 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9609 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9610 and "timer" groups.
9611
9612 @emph{example:}
9613 @example
9614 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9615 @end example
9616
9617
9618 @end deffn
9619 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9620 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9621
9622 @emph{group} can be "system",
9623 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9624 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9625 @end deffn
9626
9627 @section RISC-V Architecture
9628
9629 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9630 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9631 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9632 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9633 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9634 implement version 0.11.
9635
9636 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9637
9638 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9639 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9640 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9641
9642 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9643
9644 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9645 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9646 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9647
9648 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9649 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9650 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9651 CSRs.
9652 @end deffn
9653
9654 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9655 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9656 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9657 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9658 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9659 This command must be executed before `init`.
9660 @end deffn
9661
9662 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9663 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9664 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9665 @end deffn
9666
9667 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9668 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9669 deasserted.
9670 @end deffn
9671
9672 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9673 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9674 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9675 @end deffn
9676
9677 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9678 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9679 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9680 @end deffn
9681
9682 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9683 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9684 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9685 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9686 values.
9687
9688 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9689 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9690 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9694
9695 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9696 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9697 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9698 @example
9699 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9700 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9701 @end example
9702
9703 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9704 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9705 @end deffn
9706
9707 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9708 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9709 @end deffn
9710
9711 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9712
9713 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9714 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9715
9716 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9717 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9718 @end deffn
9719
9720 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9721 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9722 @end deffn
9723
9724 @section ARC Architecture
9725 @cindex ARC
9726
9727 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9728 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9729 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9730 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9731 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9732 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9733 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9734 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9735 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9736 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9737 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9738 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9739 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9740 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9741 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9742
9743
9744 @subsection General ARC commands
9745
9746 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9747
9748 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9749 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9750 arguments:
9751
9752 @itemize @bullet
9753
9754 @item @code{-name} name
9755 @*Name of a register.
9756
9757 @item @code{-num} number
9758 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9759
9760 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9761 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9762
9763 @end itemize
9764
9765 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9766
9767 @itemize @bullet
9768
9769 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
9770 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
9771 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
9772 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
9773 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
9774 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
9775
9776 @item @code{-core}
9777 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
9778 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
9779 spaces.
9780
9781 @item @code{-bcr}
9782 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
9783 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
9784 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
9785 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
9786 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
9787
9788 @item @code{-type} type_name
9789 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
9790 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
9791
9792 @item @code{-g}
9793 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
9794 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
9795 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
9796 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
9797 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
9798
9799 @end itemize
9800
9801 @end deffn
9802
9803 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
9804 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
9805 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
9806 @end deffn
9807
9808 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
9809 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
9810 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
9811 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
9812 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
9813 startbit endbit}.
9814 @end deffn
9815
9816 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
9817 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
9818 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
9819 @end deffn
9820
9821 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
9822 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
9823 as an argument for a single command invocation.
9824 @end deffn
9825
9826 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
9827
9828 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
9829 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
9830 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9831 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9832
9833 @end deffn
9834
9835 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
9836 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
9837 registers.
9838 @end deffn
9839
9840 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
9841 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
9842 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9843 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9844
9845 @end deffn
9846
9847 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
9848 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
9849 registers.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @section STM8 Architecture
9853 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
9854 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
9855
9856 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
9857 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
9858
9859 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9860 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9861 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9862 @cindex tracing
9863 @cindex libdcc
9864 @cindex DCC
9865 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9866 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9867 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9868 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9869
9870 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9871 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9872 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9873 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9874 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9875 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9876
9877 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9878 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9879 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9880 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9881 The target being debugged may
9882 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9883 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9884 each supported by a command:
9885
9886 @itemize
9887 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9888 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9889 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9890 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9891
9892 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9893 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9894 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9895
9896 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9897 and then displayed at any time.
9898 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9899
9900 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9901 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9902 @end itemize
9903
9904 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9905 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9906 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9907 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9908 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9909 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9910 does the same thing.
9911
9912 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9913 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9914 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9915 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9916 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9917
9918 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9919 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9920 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9921 @end deffn
9922
9923 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9924 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9925 in the order they triggered.
9926 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9927 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9928 history records.
9929 @end deffn
9930
9931 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9932 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9933 they have been triggered.
9934 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9935 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9936 and associates it with that identifier.
9937
9938 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9939 are not related except by this command.
9940 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9941 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9942 @end deffn
9943
9944
9945 @node JTAG Commands
9946 @chapter JTAG Commands
9947 @cindex JTAG Commands
9948 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9949 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9950 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9951 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9952 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9953
9954 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9955 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9956
9957 @itemize @bullet
9958 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9959 devices such as a CPUs.
9960 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9961 standard state machine (in parallel)
9962 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9963 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9964 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9965 while the reading previous ones.
9966 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9967 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9968 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9969 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9970 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9971 registers.
9972 @end itemize
9973
9974 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9975
9976 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9977 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9978 the order of TAP state transitions.
9979 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9980 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9981 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9982 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9983 these commands are not available.
9984
9985 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9986 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9987 that specify the entire register.
9988 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9989 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9990 The return value holds the original value of each
9991 of those fields.
9992
9993 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9994 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9995 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9996 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9997 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9998
9999 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10000 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10001
10002 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10003 in that state.
10004 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10005 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10006 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10007
10008 @quotation Warning
10009 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10010 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10011 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10012 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10013 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10014 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10015 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10016 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10017 @end quotation
10018 @end deffn
10019
10020 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10021 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10022 This may be used for performance tuning.
10023
10024 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10025 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10026 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10027 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10028 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10029 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10030 @end deffn
10031
10032 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10033 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10034 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10035 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10036 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10037 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10038
10039 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10040 in that state.
10041 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10042 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10043 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10044
10045 @quotation Note
10046 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10047 register values, unlike data register values.
10048 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10049 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10050 @end quotation
10051 @end deffn
10052
10053 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10054 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10055 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10056 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10057 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10058 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10059 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10060 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10061 The final state must also be stable.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10065 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10066 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10067 Instructions often need some time
10068 to execute before they take effect.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10072 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10073
10074 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10075 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10076 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10077 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10078 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10079 @end deffn
10080
10081 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10082 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10083 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10084 must also be enabled.
10085 Default is enabled.
10086 @end deffn
10087
10088 @section TAP state names
10089 @cindex TAP state names
10090
10091 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10092 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10093 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10094 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10095
10096 @itemize @bullet
10097 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10098 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10099 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10100 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10101 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10102 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10103 through the data register
10104 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10105 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10106 for update or more shifting
10107 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10108 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10109 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10110 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10111 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10112 through the instruction register
10113 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10114 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10115 for update or more shifting
10116 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10117 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10118 @end itemize
10119
10120 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10121 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10122 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10123 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10124
10125 @itemize @bullet
10126 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10127 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10128 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10129 may not be as expected.
10130 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10131 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10132 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10133 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10134 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10135 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10136 @end itemize
10137
10138 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10139 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10140
10141 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10142 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10143 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10144 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10145
10146 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10147 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10148 @cindex SVF
10149
10150 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10151 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10152 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10153 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10154
10155 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10156 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10157 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10158 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10159
10160 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10161 affect their semantics.
10162
10163 Command options:
10164 @itemize @minus
10165 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10166 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10167 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10168 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10169 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10170 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10171 on the real interface;
10172 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10173 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10174 errors.
10175 @end itemize
10176 @end deffn
10177
10178 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10179 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10180 @cindex XSVF
10181
10182 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10183 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10184 Xilinx devices.
10185 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10186 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10187
10188 @quotation Important
10189 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10190 @end quotation
10191
10192 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10193 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10194 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10195 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10196 that TAP.
10197 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10198 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10199 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10200 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10201 @end deffn
10202
10203 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10204 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10205 after building the software.
10206 You may find them useful:
10207
10208 @itemize
10209 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10210 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10211 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10212 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10213 @end itemize
10214
10215 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10216 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10217 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10218 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10219 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10220 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10221 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10222
10223
10224 @node Utility Commands
10225 @chapter Utility Commands
10226 @cindex Utility Commands
10227
10228 @section RAM testing
10229 @cindex RAM testing
10230
10231 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10232 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10233 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10234 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10235 hardware problems.
10236
10237 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10238 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10239 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10240 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10241
10242 Load the memory testing functions with
10243
10244 @example
10245 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10246 @end example
10247
10248 to get access to the following facilities:
10249
10250 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10251 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10252 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10253 @end deffn
10254
10255 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10256 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10257 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10258 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10259 @end deffn
10260
10261 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10262 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10263 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10264 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10265 @end deffn
10266
10267 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10268 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10269 @end deffn
10270
10271 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10272 @cindex Firmware recovery
10273
10274 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10275 devices recovery with JTAG.
10276
10277 For quickstart instructions run:
10278 @example
10279 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10280 @end example
10281
10282 @node TFTP
10283 @chapter TFTP
10284 @cindex TFTP
10285 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10286 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10287
10288 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10289 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10290 server (tftpd). For example,
10291
10292 @example
10293 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10294 @end example
10295
10296 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10297 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10298
10299 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10300 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10301 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10302 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10303
10304 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10305 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10306 @cindex GDB
10307 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10308 to debug remote targets.
10309 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10310
10311 @itemize
10312 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10313 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10314 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10315 as shown in this chapter.
10316 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10317 that also will probably need to be configured.
10318 @end itemize
10319
10320 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10321 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10322 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10323 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10324 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10325 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10326
10327 @section Connecting to GDB
10328 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10329 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10330 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10331 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10332 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10333
10334 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10335
10336 @enumerate
10337 @item
10338 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10339 @example
10340 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10341 @end example
10342 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10343
10344 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10345 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10346 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10347
10348 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10349 remote command above that becomes:
10350 @example
10351 tar ext :3333
10352 @end example
10353
10354 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10355 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10356 available through the command:
10357 @example
10358 target remote localhost:3333
10359 @end example
10360
10361 @item
10362 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10363 @example
10364 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10365 @end example
10366 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10367 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10368 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10369 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10370 @end enumerate
10371
10372 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10373 GDB command line.
10374
10375 @section Sample GDB session startup
10376
10377 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10378 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10379 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10380 small ARM program.
10381 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10382 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10383
10384 @example
10385 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10386 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10387 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10388 ...
10389 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10390 ...
10391 (gdb) load
10392 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10393 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10394 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10395 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10396 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10397 (gdb) continue
10398 Continuing.
10399 ...
10400 @end example
10401
10402 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10403 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10404 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10405 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10406
10407 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10408
10409 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10410 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10411 packet size and the device's memory map.
10412 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10413 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10414 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10415
10416 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10417 You may need to set those up by hand.
10418 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10419 something like:
10420
10421 @example
10422 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10423 @end example
10424
10425 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10426
10427 @example
10428 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10429 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10430 @end example
10431
10432 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10433 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10434 do not have such restrictions.
10435
10436 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10437 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10438 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10439 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10440
10441 @section Programming using GDB
10442 @cindex Programming using GDB
10443 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10444
10445 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10446 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10447 @example
10448 gdb_memory_map disable
10449 @end example
10450 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10451 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10452 working area.
10453
10454 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10455 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10456 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10457 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10458
10459 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10460 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10461
10462 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10463 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10464 @example
10465 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10466 @end example
10467
10468 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10469 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10470
10471 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10472 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10473 will be used.
10474
10475 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10476 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10477 @example
10478 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10479 @end example
10480 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10481
10482 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10483 can be used.
10484
10485 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10486 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10487 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10488
10489 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10490 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10491 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10492
10493 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10494 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10495 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10496 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10497 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10498 without any intrusion of the target process.
10499
10500 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10501 Place following command after target configuration:
10502 @example
10503 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10504 @end example
10505
10506 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10507 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10508 @example
10509 gdb_memory_map disable
10510 @end example
10511
10512 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10513 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10514 @example
10515 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10516 @end example
10517
10518 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10519 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10520
10521 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10522 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10523 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10524 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10525
10526 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10527 previously shown varibles.
10528
10529 @section RTOS Support
10530 @cindex RTOS Support
10531 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10532
10533 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10534 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10535
10536 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10537 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10538 GDB commands.
10539
10540 @* An example setup is below:
10541
10542 @example
10543 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10544 @end example
10545
10546 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10547
10548 Currently supported rtos's include:
10549 @itemize @bullet
10550 @item @option{eCos}
10551 @item @option{ThreadX}
10552 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10553 @item @option{linux}
10554 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10555 @item @option{embKernel}
10556 @item @option{mqx}
10557 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10558 @item @option{nuttx}
10559 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10560 @end itemize
10561
10562 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10563 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10564
10565 @table @code
10566 @item eCos symbols
10567 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10568 @item ThreadX symbols
10569 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10570 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10571 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10572 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10573 @tex
10574 \begingroup
10575 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10576 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10577 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10578 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10579 \par
10580 \endgroup
10581 @end tex
10582 @item linux symbols
10583 init_task.
10584 @item ChibiOS symbols
10585 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10586 @item embKernel symbols
10587 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10588 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10589 @item mqx symbols
10590 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10591 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10592 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10593 @item nuttx symbols
10594 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10595 @end table
10596
10597 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10598 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10599
10600 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10601 along with the project:
10602
10603 @table @code
10604 @item FreeRTOS
10605 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10606 @item uC/OS-III
10607 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10608 @end table
10609
10610 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10611 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10612 @cindex SMP
10613 @cindex RTOS
10614 @cindex hwthread
10615 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10616 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10617 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10618 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10619 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10620 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10621 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10622 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10623 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10624
10625 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10626 @quotation Note
10627 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10628 @end quotation
10629
10630 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10631 @itemize @bullet
10632 @item j - smp status request
10633 @item J - smp set request
10634 @end itemize
10635
10636 OpenOCD implements :
10637 @itemize @bullet
10638 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10639 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10640 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10641 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10642 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10643 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10644 @end itemize
10645
10646 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10647 @itemize @bullet
10648 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10649 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10650 @example
10651 set $_core 1
10652 #Jc01 packet is sent
10653 print $_core
10654 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10655 @end example
10656
10657 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10658 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10659
10660 @example
10661 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10662 define toggle0
10663 maint packet Jc0
10664 continue
10665 main packet Jc-1
10666 end
10667 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10668 define toggle1
10669 maint packet Jc1
10670 continue
10671 main packet Jc-1
10672 end
10673 @end example
10674 @end itemize
10675
10676 @node Tcl Scripting API
10677 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10678 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10679 @cindex Tcl scripts
10680 @section API rules
10681
10682 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10683 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10684 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10685
10686 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10687 pair list and lists.
10688
10689 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10690 list.
10691
10692 @example
10693 > set foo(me) Duane
10694 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10695 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10696 > set foo(duck) Donald
10697 @end example
10698
10699 If one does this:
10700
10701 @example
10702 > set foo
10703 @end example
10704
10705 The result is:
10706
10707 @example
10708 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10709 @end example
10710
10711 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10712
10713 @verbatim
10714 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10715 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10716 }
10717 @end verbatim
10718
10719 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10720 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10721
10722 @section Internal low-level Commands
10723
10724 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10725 invoke directly.
10726
10727 @itemize @bullet
10728 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10729
10730 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10731 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10732
10733 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10734 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10735
10736 Return information about the flash banks
10737
10738 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10739
10740 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10741 its execution. Example:
10742
10743 @example
10744 > capture "reset init"
10745 @end example
10746
10747 @end itemize
10748
10749 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10750 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10751 called "flash_banks".
10752
10753 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10754
10755 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10756 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10757 holds one of the following values:
10758
10759 @itemize @bullet
10760 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10761 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10762 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10763 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10764 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10765 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10766 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10767 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10768 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10769 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10770 @end itemize
10771
10772 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10773
10774 @quotation Note
10775 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10776 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10777 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10778 is jim, not real tcl).
10779 @end quotation
10780
10781 @section Tcl RPC server
10782 @cindex RPC
10783
10784 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10785 commands and receive the results.
10786
10787 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10788 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10789 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10790 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10791 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10792
10793 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10794 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10795 @command{capture} command.
10796
10797 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10798
10799 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10800 @cindex RPC Notifications
10801
10802 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10803 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10804
10805 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10806 in the following format.
10807
10808 @verbatim
10809 type target_event event [event-name]
10810 type target_state state [state-name]
10811 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10812 @end verbatim
10813
10814 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10815 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10816 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10817 Defaults to off.
10818
10819 @end deffn
10820
10821 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10822 @cindex RPC trace output
10823
10824 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10825 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10826
10827 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10828
10829 @verbatim
10830 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10831 @end verbatim
10832
10833 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10834 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10835 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10836 Defaults to off.
10837
10838 See an example application here:
10839 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10840
10841 @end deffn
10842
10843 @node FAQ
10844 @chapter FAQ
10845 @cindex faq
10846 @enumerate
10847 @anchor{faqrtck}
10848 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10849 @cindex RTCK
10850 @cindex adaptive clocking
10851 @*
10852
10853 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10854 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10855 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10856 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10857
10858 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10859 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10860 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10861 @enumerate
10862 @item
10863 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10864 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10865 @item
10866 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10867 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10868 @end enumerate
10869
10870 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10871 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10872 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10873 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10874 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10875 power).
10876
10877 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10878 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10879 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10880 ARM926 scenario).
10881 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10882 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10883 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10884
10885 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10886 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10887 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10888 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10889
10890 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10891
10892 In order to make use of this,
10893 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10894 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10895
10896 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10897 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10898 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10899 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10900 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10901
10902 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10903 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10904 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10905 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10906
10907 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10908 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10909 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10910 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10911 with a CPLD.
10912 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10913 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10914 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10915 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10916 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10917 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10918
10919 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10920
10921 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10922
10923 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10924 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10925 depending on the chips on your board.
10926 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10927 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10928 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10929
10930 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10931 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10932 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10933
10934 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10935 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10936 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10937 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10938
10939 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10940 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10941 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10942 this way.
10943
10944 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10945 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10946 clock rate.
10947 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10948 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10949 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10950
10951 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10952
10953 @example
10954 # Example: 1.234MHz
10955 adapter speed 1234
10956 @end example
10957
10958
10959 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10960
10961 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10962 around Windows filenames.
10963
10964 @example
10965 > echo \a
10966
10967 > echo @{\a@}
10968 \a
10969 > echo "\a"
10970
10971 >
10972 @end example
10973
10974
10975 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10976
10977 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10978 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10979 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10980
10981 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10982 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10983 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10984
10985 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10986 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10987 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10988
10989 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10990
10991 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10992 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10993 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10994 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10995
10996 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10997 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10998 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10999
11000 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11001 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11002
11003 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11004 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11005 memory read caused data abort".
11006
11007 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11008 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11009 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11010 be done, feel free to add this here.
11011
11012 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11013 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11014 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11015 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11016 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11017 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11018 gracefully stops.
11019
11020 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11021 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11022 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11023
11024 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11025 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11026 bytes. Painful...
11027
11028
11029 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11030 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11031
11032 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11033 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11034 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11035 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11036 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11037 reset, everything else should work fine.
11038
11039 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11040 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11041 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11042 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11043
11044 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11045 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11046 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11047 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11048
11049 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11050
11051 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11052 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11053 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11054
11055 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11056 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11057
11058 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11059 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11060 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11061 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11062 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11063 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11064 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11065 clock frequency?
11066
11067 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11068 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11069 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11070 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11071 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11072
11073 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11074
11075 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11076 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11077 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11078 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11079 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11080 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11081 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11082
11083 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11084
11085 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11086 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11087 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11088 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11089
11090 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11091 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11092 particular order?
11093
11094 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11095 the same order used by the hardware.
11096
11097 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11098 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11099 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11100 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11101 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11102 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11103
11104 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11105 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11106 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11107 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11108
11109 @itemize @bullet
11110 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11111 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11112 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11113 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11114 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11115 @end itemize
11116
11117 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11118
11119 @itemize @bullet
11120 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11121 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11122 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11123 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11124 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11125 @end itemize
11126
11127
11128 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11129 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11130 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11131
11132 TODO.
11133
11134 @end enumerate
11135
11136 @node Tcl Crash Course
11137 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11138 @cindex Tcl
11139
11140 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11141 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11142 how the Tcl scripts work.
11143
11144 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11145 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11146 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11147 OpenOCD.
11148
11149 @section Tcl Rule #1
11150 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11151 @enumerate
11152 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11153 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11154 @end enumerate
11155
11156 The Tcl equal is this:
11157
11158 @enumerate
11159 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11160 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11161 @end enumerate
11162
11163 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11164 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11165
11166 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11167 There is a second pair of rules.
11168 @enumerate
11169 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11170 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11171 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11172 in Tcl.
11173 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11174 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11175 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11176 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11177 @end enumerate
11178
11179 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11180 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11181 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11182 Everything is a string}
11183
11184 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11185 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11186 difference is subtle.
11187 @enumerate
11188 @item Parse Time
11189 @item Evaluation Time
11190 @end enumerate
11191
11192 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11193 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11194 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11195
11196 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11197 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11198 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11199 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11200
11201 @itemize @bullet
11202 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11203 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11204 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11205 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11206 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11207 @example
11208 # bash example
11209 X=`date`
11210 echo "The Date is: $X"
11211 # Tcl example
11212 set X [date]
11213 puts "The Date is: $X"
11214 @end example
11215 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11216 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11217 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11218 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11219 is a string}
11220 @example
11221 set x "Dinner"
11222 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11223 @end example
11224 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11225 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11226 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11227 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11228 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11229 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11230 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11231 @end itemize
11232
11233 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11234
11235 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11236
11237 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11238
11239 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11240 the normal way.
11241
11242 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11243 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11244 line is immediately executed.
11245
11246 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11247 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11248
11249 @subsection Command Execution
11250
11251 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11252 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11253 control flow operators.
11254
11255 Commands are executed like this:
11256
11257 @enumerate
11258 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11259 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11260 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11261 @end enumerate
11262
11263 It sort of works like this:
11264 @example
11265 for(;;)@{
11266 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11267
11268 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11269
11270 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11271 @}
11272 @end example
11273
11274 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11275 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11276 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11277 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11278 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11279 ``LookupCommand()''
11280
11281 @subsection The FOR command
11282
11283 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11284 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11285 command just like any other command.
11286
11287 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11288 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11289 are:
11290
11291 @enumerate 0
11292 @item The ascii text 'for'
11293 @item The start text
11294 @item The test expression
11295 @item The next text
11296 @item The body text
11297 @end enumerate
11298
11299 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11300 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11301 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11302 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11303
11304 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11305 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11306
11307 @example
11308 int
11309 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11310 int *argc,
11311 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11312 @end example
11313
11314 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11315 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11316 still operates in the same basic way.
11317
11318 @subsection FOR command implementation
11319
11320 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11321 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11322
11323 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11324
11325 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11326
11327 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11328 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11329 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11330
11331 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11332 expression and returns a value.
11333
11334 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11335 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11336 @example
11337 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11338
11339 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11340
11341 int
11342 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11343 int argc,
11344 char **argv )
11345 @{
11346 if( argc != 5 )@{
11347 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11348 return ERROR;
11349 @}
11350
11351 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11352
11353 // Execute the start statement.
11354 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11355
11356 // Top of loop test
11357 for(;;)@{
11358 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11359 if( i == 0 )
11360 break;
11361
11362 // Execute the body
11363 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11364
11365 // Execute the LOOP part
11366 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11367 @}
11368
11369 // Return no error
11370 SetResult( interp, "" );
11371 return SUCCESS;
11372 @}
11373 @end example
11374
11375 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11376 in the same basic way.
11377
11378 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11379
11380 @subsection source and find commands
11381 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11382 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11383 @*Remember the parsing rules
11384 @enumerate
11385 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11386 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11387 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11388 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11389 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11390 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11391 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11392 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11393 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11394 @end enumerate
11395 @subsection format command
11396 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11397 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11398 @b{sprintf()}.
11399 @b{Example}
11400 @example
11401 set x 6
11402 set y 7
11403 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11404 @end example
11405 @enumerate
11406 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11407 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11408 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11409 @* Refer to Rule #1
11410 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11411 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11412 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11413 @end enumerate
11414 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11415 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11416 @example
11417 #1 Good
11418 proc someproc @{@} @{
11419 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11420 @}
11421 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11422 #2 Good - no variables
11423 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11424 #3 Good Curly Braces
11425 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11426 puts "Time: [date]"
11427 @}
11428 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11429 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11430 @end example
11431 @enumerate
11432 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11433 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11434 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11435 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11436 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11437 command.
11438 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11439 @*There are 4 examples:
11440 @enumerate
11441 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11442 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11443 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11444 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11445 @end enumerate
11446
11447 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11448 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11449 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11450
11451 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11452 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11453 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11454 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11455 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11456 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11457 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11458 @end enumerate
11459 @subsection Global Variables
11460 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11461 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11462 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11463 @example
11464 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11465 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11466 global x #Global variable X
11467 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11468 @}
11469 @end example
11470 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11471 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11472 @example
11473 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11474 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11475 # Create var name
11476 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11477 # Make it a global
11478 global $vn
11479 # Set it.
11480 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11481 @}
11482 @end example
11483 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11484 @example
11485 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11486 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11487 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11488 @}
11489 @end example
11490
11491 @include fdl.texi
11492
11493 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11494 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11495 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11496 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11497 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11498 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11499
11500 @printindex cp
11501
11502 @node Command and Driver Index
11503 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11504 @printindex fn
11505
11506 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)